tm.texi revision 110611
1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,2002
2@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3@c This is part of the GCC manual.
4@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
5
6@node Target Macros
7@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
8@cindex machine description macros
9@cindex target description macros
10@cindex macros, target description
11@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
12
13In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
14includes a C header file conventionally given the name
15@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
16The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
17about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
18@file{.md} file.  The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
19@file{@var{machine}.h}.  The header file @file{config.h} includes
20@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}.  The
21source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
22containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
23machine.  @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
24if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
25through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
26
27@menu
28* Target Structure::    The @code{targetm} variable.
29* Driver::              Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
30* Run-time Target::     Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
31* Per-Function Data::   Defining data structures for per-function information.
32* Storage Layout::      Defining sizes and alignments of data.
33* Type Layout::         Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
34* Escape Sequences::    Defining the value of target character escape sequences
35* Registers::           Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes::    Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Stack and Calling::   Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
38* Varargs::		Defining the varargs macros.
39* Trampolines::         Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
40* Library Calls::       Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
41* Addressing Modes::    Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
42* Condition Code::      Defining how insns update the condition code.
43* Costs::               Defining relative costs of different operations.
44* Scheduling::          Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
45* Sections::            Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
46* PIC::			Macros for position independent code.
47* Assembler Format::    Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
48* Debugging Info::      Defining the format of debugging output.
49* Cross-compilation::   Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
50* Mode Switching::      Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
51* Target Attributes::   Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
52* Misc::                Everything else.
53@end menu
54
55@node Target Structure
56@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
57@cindex target hooks
58@cindex target functions
59
60@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
61The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
62which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
63machine.  The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
64@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
65used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
66for elements of the structure.  The @file{.c} file should override those
67macros for which the default definition is inappropriate.  For example:
68@smallexample
69#include "target.h"
70#include "target-def.h"
71
72/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.}  */
73
74#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
75#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
76
77struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
78@end smallexample
79@end deftypevar
80
81Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
82form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
83``Target Hook'' with a prototype.  Many macros will change in future
84from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
85@code{targetm} structure.
86
87@node Driver
88@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
89@cindex driver
90@cindex controlling the compilation driver
91
92@c prevent bad page break with this line
93You can control the compilation driver.
94
95@table @code
96@findex SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
97@item SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
98A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
99takes arguments.  The value should be the number of arguments that
100option takes--zero, for many options.
101
102By default, this macro is defined as
103@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
104properly.  You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
105wish to add additional options which take arguments.  Any redefinition
106should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
107additional options.
108
109@findex WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
110@item WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
111A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
112takes arguments.  The value should be the number of arguments that
113option takes--zero, for many options.  This macro rather than
114@code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
115
116By default, this macro is defined as
117@code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
118properly.  You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
119wish to add additional options which take arguments.  Any redefinition
120should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
121additional options.
122
123@findex SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION
124@item SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
125A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
126stops compilation before the generation of an executable.  The value is
127boolean, nonzero if the option does stop an executable from being
128generated, zero otherwise.
129
130By default, this macro is defined as
131@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
132options properly.  You need not define
133@code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
134options which affect the generation of an executable.  Any redefinition
135should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
136for additional options.
137
138@findex SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
139@item SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
140A string-valued C expression which enumerates the options for which
141the linker needs a space between the option and its argument.
142
143If this macro is not defined, the default value is @code{""}.
144
145@findex TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
146@item TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
147If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
148potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
149second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
150supported) list of options with which to replace the first option.  The
151target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
152are valid.  Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
153must be the @code{-opt} style.  It is the intention of this macro to
154provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
155such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
156multilibs.  Example nonsensical definition, where @code{-malt-abi},
157@code{-EB}, and @code{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
158
159@smallexample
160#define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
161@{ "-fast",   "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
162@{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
163@end smallexample
164
165@findex CPP_SPEC
166@item CPP_SPEC
167A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
168pass to CPP@.  It can also specify how to translate options you
169give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
170
171Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
172
173@findex CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
174@item CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
175This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
176than C@.  If you do not define this macro, then the value of
177@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
178
179@findex NO_BUILTIN_SIZE_TYPE
180@item NO_BUILTIN_SIZE_TYPE
181If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
182@code{__SIZE_TYPE__}.  The macro @code{__SIZE_TYPE__} must then be defined
183by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
184
185This should be defined if @code{SIZE_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
186which are not accessible to the preprocessor.  Otherwise, it should not
187be defined.
188
189@findex NO_BUILTIN_PTRDIFF_TYPE
190@item NO_BUILTIN_PTRDIFF_TYPE
191If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
192@code{__PTRDIFF_TYPE__}.  The macro @code{__PTRDIFF_TYPE__} must then be
193defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
194
195This should be defined if @code{PTRDIFF_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
196which are not accessible to the preprocessor.  Otherwise, it should not
197be defined.
198
199@findex NO_BUILTIN_WCHAR_TYPE
200@item NO_BUILTIN_WCHAR_TYPE
201If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
202@code{__WCHAR_TYPE__}.  The macro @code{__WCHAR_TYPE__} must then be
203defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
204
205This should be defined if @code{WCHAR_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
206which are not accessible to the preprocessor.  Otherwise, it should not
207be defined.
208
209@findex NO_BUILTIN_WINT_TYPE
210@item NO_BUILTIN_WINT_TYPE
211If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
212@code{__WINT_TYPE__}.  The macro @code{__WINT_TYPE__} must then be
213defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
214
215This should be defined if @code{WINT_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
216which are not accessible to the preprocessor.  Otherwise, it should not
217be defined.
218
219@findex CC1_SPEC
220@item CC1_SPEC
221A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
223front ends.
224It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
225for GCC to pass to front ends.
226
227Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
228
229@findex CC1PLUS_SPEC
230@item CC1PLUS_SPEC
231A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
232pass to @code{cc1plus}.  It can also specify how to translate options you
233give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
234
235Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
236Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
237@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
238CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
239
240@findex ASM_SPEC
241@item ASM_SPEC
242A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
243pass to the assembler.  It can also specify how to translate options
244you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
245See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
246
247Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
248
249@findex ASM_FINAL_SPEC
250@item ASM_FINAL_SPEC
251A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
252run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
253Normally, this is not needed.  See the file @file{mips.h} for
254an example of this.
255
256Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
257
258@findex LINK_SPEC
259@item LINK_SPEC
260A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
261pass to the linker.  It can also specify how to translate options you
262give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
263
264Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
265
266@findex LIB_SPEC
267@item LIB_SPEC
268Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The difference
269between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
270command given to the linker.
271
272If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
273loads the standard C library from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
274
275@findex LIBGCC_SPEC
276@item LIBGCC_SPEC
277Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
278how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
279linker command line.  This constant is placed both before and after
280the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
281
282If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
283passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
284
285@findex STARTFILE_SPEC
286@item STARTFILE_SPEC
287Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
288difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
289the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
290
291If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
292standard C startup file from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
293
294@findex ENDFILE_SPEC
295@item ENDFILE_SPEC
296Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
297difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
298the very end of the command given to the linker.
299
300Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
301
302@findex THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
303@item THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
304GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
305However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
306models, such as AIX 4.3.  On such platforms, define
307@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
308blanks that names one of the recognized thread models.  @code{%*}, the
309default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
310@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
311
312@findex EXTRA_SPECS
313@item EXTRA_SPECS
314Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
315@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
316@code{CC1_SPEC}.
317
318The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
319containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
320string constant that provides the specification.
321
322Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
323
324@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
325related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
326to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
327these definitions.
328
329For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
330define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
331used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
332used.
333
334The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
335
336@example
337#define EXTRA_SPECS \
338  @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
339
340#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
341@end example
342
343The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
344@smallexample
345#undef CPP_SPEC
346#define CPP_SPEC \
347"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
348%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} %@{mcall-aix: -D_CALL_AIX @} \
349%@{!mcall-sysv: %@{!mcall-aix: %(cpp_sysv_default) @}@} \
350%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
351
352#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
353#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
354@end smallexample
355
356while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
357@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
358
359@smallexample
360#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
361#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
362@end smallexample
363
364@findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
365@item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
366Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
367@file{libgcc.a} itself and should not pass @option{-L} options to the
368linker.  If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
369the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search and will
370pass @option{-L} options to it.
371
372@findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
373@item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
374Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
375@file{libgcc.a}.  If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
376the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
377This macro is similar to @code{LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL}, except that it does
378not affect @option{-L} options.
379
380@findex LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
381@item LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
382The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
383By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
384
385@findex LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
386@item LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
387A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
388linker.  When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
389change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}.  Therefore,
390define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
391line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
392the effect you need.  Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
393@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
394
395@findex LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
396@item LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
397A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
398directories from linking commands.  Do not give it a nonzero value if
399removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
400
401@findex MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
402@item MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
403Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
404string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
405target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
406@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
407
408Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
409the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
410@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
411@xref{Target Fragment}.
412
413@findex RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
414@item RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
415Define this macro to tell @code{gcc} that it should only translate
416a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
417indicates an absolute file name.
418
419@findex STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
420@item STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
421Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc-lib/} as the default prefix to
423try when searching for the executable files of the compiler.
424
425@findex MD_EXEC_PREFIX
426@item MD_EXEC_PREFIX
427If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
428@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
429when the @option{-b} option is used, or the compiler is built as a cross
430compiler.  If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
431to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
432
433@findex STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
434@item STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
435Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
436standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/} as the default prefix to
437try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
438
439@findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
440@item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
441If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
442standard prefixes.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
443@option{-b} option is used, or when the compiler is built as a cross
444compiler.
445
446@findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
447@item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
448If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
449standard prefixes.  It is not searched when the @option{-b} option is
450used, or when the compiler is built as a cross compiler.
451
452@findex INIT_ENVIRONMENT
453@item INIT_ENVIRONMENT
454Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
455variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
456loader.  The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
457initialize the necessary environment variables.
458
459@findex LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
460@item LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
461Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
462standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
463try when searching for local header files.  @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
464comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
465
466Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
467replacement.
468
469@findex MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
470@item MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
471Define this macro if you with to define command-line switches that modify the
472default target name
473
474For each switch, you can include a string to be appended to the first
475part of the configuration name or a string to be deleted from the
476configuration name, if present.  The definition should be an initializer
477for an array of structures.  Each array element should have three
478elements: the switch name (a string constant, including the initial
479dash), one of the enumeration codes @code{ADD} or @code{DELETE} to
480indicate whether the string should be inserted or deleted, and the string
481to be inserted or deleted (a string constant).
482
483For example, on a machine where @samp{64} at the end of the
484configuration name denotes a 64-bit target and you want the @option{-32}
485and @option{-64} switches to select between 32- and 64-bit targets, you would
486code
487
488@smallexample
489#define MODIFY_TARGET_NAME \
490  @{ @{ "-32", DELETE, "64"@}, \
491     @{"-64", ADD, "64"@}@}
492@end smallexample
493
494
495@findex SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
496@item SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
497Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
498system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
499directory.  @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
500@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
501
502Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
503specified.
504
505@findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
506@item STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
507Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
508standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
509try when searching for header files.
510
511Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search either
512@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
513
514@findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
515@item STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
516The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
517See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
518If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
519
520@findex INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
521@item INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
522Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
523for include files.  For a native compiler, the default search path
524usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
525@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
526@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.  In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
527and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
528and specify private search areas for GCC@.  The directory
529@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
530
531The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
532Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
533string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
534for C++-only directories,
535and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
536wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++.  Mark the end of
537the array with a null element.
538
539The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
540if any, in all upper-case letters.  For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
541or @samp{BINUTILS}.  If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
542operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
543
544For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
545
546@example
547#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
548@{                                       \
549  @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@},   \
550  @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@},    \
551  @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@},  \
552  @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@},                      \
553  @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@}                         \
554@}
555@end example
556@end table
557
558Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
559
560@enumerate
561@item
562Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
563
564@item
565The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
566
567@item
568The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
569
570@item
571The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
572
573@item
574@file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
575
576@item
577The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
578@end enumerate
579
580Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
581
582@enumerate
583@item
584Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
585
586@item
587The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
588
589@item
590The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
591(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
592
593@item
594The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
595
596@item
597@file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
598
599@item
600The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
601
602@item
603The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if any.
604
605@item
606The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}.
607
608@item
609@file{/lib/}.
610
611@item
612@file{/usr/lib/}.
613@end enumerate
614
615@node Run-time Target
616@section Run-time Target Specification
617@cindex run-time target specification
618@cindex predefined macros
619@cindex target specifications
620
621@c prevent bad page break with this line
622Here are run-time target specifications.
623
624@table @code
625@findex CPP_PREDEFINES
626@item CPP_PREDEFINES
627Define this to be a string constant containing @option{-D} options to
628define the predefined macros that identify this machine and system.
629These macros will be predefined unless the @option{-ansi} option (or a
630@option{-std} option for strict ISO C conformance) is specified.
631
632In addition, a parallel set of macros are predefined, whose names are
633made by appending @samp{__} at the beginning and at the end.  These
634@samp{__} macros are permitted by the ISO standard, so they are
635predefined regardless of whether @option{-ansi} or a @option{-std} option
636is specified.
637
638For example, on the Sun, one can use the following value:
639
640@smallexample
641"-Dmc68000 -Dsun -Dunix"
642@end smallexample
643
644The result is to define the macros @code{__mc68000__}, @code{__sun__}
645and @code{__unix__} unconditionally, and the macros @code{mc68000},
646@code{sun} and @code{unix} provided @option{-ansi} is not specified.
647
648@findex extern int target_flags
649@item extern int target_flags;
650This declaration should be present.
651
652@cindex optional hardware or system features
653@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
654@item TARGET_@dots{}
655This series of macros is to allow compiler command arguments to
656enable or disable the use of optional features of the target machine.
657For example, one machine description serves both the 68000 and
658the 68020; a command argument tells the compiler whether it should
659use 68020-only instructions or not.  This command argument works
660by means of a macro @code{TARGET_68020} that tests a bit in
661@code{target_flags}.
662
663Define a macro @code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} for each such option.
664Its definition should test a bit in @code{target_flags}.  It is
665recommended that a helper macro @code{TARGET_MASK_@var{featurename}}
666is defined for each bit-value to test, and used in
667@code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} and @code{TARGET_SWITCHES}.  For
668example:
669
670@smallexample
671#define TARGET_MASK_68020 1
672#define TARGET_68020 (target_flags & TARGET_MASK_68020)
673@end smallexample
674
675One place where these macros are used is in the condition-expressions
676of instruction patterns.  Note how @code{TARGET_68020} appears
677frequently in the 68000 machine description file, @file{m68k.md}.
678Another place they are used is in the definitions of the other
679macros in the @file{@var{machine}.h} file.
680
681@findex TARGET_SWITCHES
682@item TARGET_SWITCHES
683This macro defines names of command options to set and clear
684bits in @code{target_flags}.  Its definition is an initializer
685with a subgrouping for each command option.
686
687Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the option
688name, a number, which contains the bits to set in
689@code{target_flags}, and a second string which is the description
690displayed by @option{--help}.  If the number is negative then the bits specified
691by the number are cleared instead of being set.  If the description
692string is present but empty, then no help information will be displayed
693for that option, but it will not count as an undocumented option.  The
694actual option name is made by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name.
695Non-empty description strings should be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})} for
696@command{xgettext}.  Please do not mark empty strings because the empty
697string is reserved by GNU gettext. @code{gettext("")} returns the header entry
698of the message catalog with meta information, not the empty string.
699
700In addition to the description for @option{--help},
701more detailed documentation for each option should be added to
702@file{invoke.texi}.
703
704One of the subgroupings should have a null string.  The number in
705this grouping is the default value for @code{target_flags}.  Any
706target options act starting with that value.
707
708Here is an example which defines @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}
709with opposite meanings, and picks the latter as the default:
710
711@smallexample
712#define TARGET_SWITCHES \
713  @{ @{ "68020", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @},      \
714    @{ "68000", -TARGET_MASK_68020, \
715      N_("Compile for the 68000") @}, \
716    @{ "", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @}@}
717@end smallexample
718
719@findex TARGET_OPTIONS
720@item TARGET_OPTIONS
721This macro is similar to @code{TARGET_SWITCHES} but defines names of command
722options that have values.  Its definition is an initializer with a
723subgrouping for each command option.
724
725Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the fixed part
726of the option name, the address of a variable, and a description string.
727Non-empty description strings should be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})} for
728@command{xgettext}.  Please do not mark empty strings because the empty
729string is reserved by GNU gettext. @code{gettext("")} returns the header entry
730of the message catalog with meta information, not the empty string.
731
732The variable, type @code{char *}, is set to the variable part of the
733given option if the fixed part matches.  The actual option name is made
734by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name.  Again, each option should
735also be documented in @file{invoke.texi}.
736
737Here is an example which defines @option{-mshort-data-@var{number}}.  If the
738given option is @option{-mshort-data-512}, the variable @code{m88k_short_data}
739will be set to the string @code{"512"}.
740
741@smallexample
742extern char *m88k_short_data;
743#define TARGET_OPTIONS \
744 @{ @{ "short-data-", &m88k_short_data, \
745     N_("Specify the size of the short data section") @} @}
746@end smallexample
747
748@findex TARGET_VERSION
749@item TARGET_VERSION
750This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
751describing the particular machine description choice.  Every machine
752description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}.  For example:
753
754@smallexample
755#ifdef MOTOROLA
756#define TARGET_VERSION \
757  fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
758#else
759#define TARGET_VERSION \
760  fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
761#endif
762@end smallexample
763
764@findex OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
765@item OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
766Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
767a particular target machine.  You can define a macro
768@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} to take account of this.  This macro, if
769defined, is executed once just after all the command options have been
770parsed.
771
772Don't use this macro to turn on various extra optimizations for
773@option{-O}.  That is what @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} is for.
774
775@findex OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS
776@item OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS (@var{level}, @var{size})
777Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
778various optimization levels.   This macro, if defined, is executed once
779just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
780of the command options have been parsed.  Values set in this macro are
781used as the default values for the other command line options.
782
783@var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
784specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
785
786@var{size} is nonzero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
787
788You should not use this macro to change options that are not
789machine-specific.  These should uniformly selected by the same
790optimization level on all supported machines.  Use this macro to enable
791machine-specific optimizations.
792
793@strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
794this macro!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
795generated code.
796
797@findex CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
798@item CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
799Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
800pointer.  If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
801@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
802@end table
803
804@node Per-Function Data
805@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
806@cindex per-function data
807@cindex data structures
808
809If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
810provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this.  Note, just
811using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
812nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
813when another one comes along.
814
815GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
816contains all of the data specific to an individual function.  This
817structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
818@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
819to their own specific data.
820
821If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
822@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro
823@code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.  This macro should be used to initialize some or
824all of the function pointers @code{init_machine_status},
825@code{free_machine_status} and @code{mark_machine_status}.  These
826pointers are explained below.
827
828One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
829RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address.  This
830RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
831function, for level 0.
832
833Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
834all of the per-function information.  Thus when processing of a nested
835function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
836stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
837stack.  GCC used to provide function pointers called
838@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
839the saving and restoring of the target specific information.  Since the
840single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
841longer supported.
842
843The macro and function pointers are described below.
844
845@table @code
846@findex INIT_EXPANDERS
847@item   INIT_EXPANDERS
848Macro called to initialize any target specific information.  This macro
849is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
850The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
851function pointers below.
852
853@findex init_machine_status
854@item   init_machine_status
855This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer.  If this
856pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per function, before function
857compilation starts, in order to allow the target to perform any target
858specific initialization of the @code{struct function} structure.  It is
859intended that this would be used to initialize the @code{machine} of
860that structure.
861
862@findex free_machine_status
863@item   free_machine_status
864This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer.  If this
865pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per function, after the
866function has been compiled, in order to allow any memory allocated
867during the @code{init_machine_status} function call to be freed.
868
869@findex mark_machine_status
870@item   mark_machine_status
871This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer.  If this
872pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per function in order to mark
873any data items in the @code{struct machine_function} structure which
874need garbage collection.
875
876@end table
877
878@node Storage Layout
879@section Storage Layout
880@cindex storage layout
881
882Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
883alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant.  They can be C
884expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
885@xref{Run-time Target}.
886
887@table @code
888@findex BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
889@item BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
890Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
891byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
892This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
893bit.  If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
894be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to.  This
895macro need not be a constant.
896
897This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
898bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
899
900@findex BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
901@item BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
902Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
903word has the lowest number.  This macro need not be a constant.
904
905@findex WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
906@item WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
907Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
908most significant word has the lowest number.  This applies to both
909memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
910order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers.  This
911macro need not be a constant.
912
913@findex LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
914@item LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
915Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant.  This must be a
916constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
917used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}.  Typically the value will be set
918based on preprocessor defines.
919
920@findex FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
921@item FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
922Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
923@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
924containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
925have the value 0.  This macro need not be a constant.
926
927You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
928multi-word integers.
929
930@findex BITS_PER_UNIT
931@item BITS_PER_UNIT
932Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
933unit (byte); normally 8.
934
935@findex BITS_PER_WORD
936@item BITS_PER_WORD
937Number of bits in a word; normally 32.
938
939@findex MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
940@item MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
941Maximum number of bits in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
942@code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
943largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
944
945@findex UNITS_PER_WORD
946@item UNITS_PER_WORD
947Number of storage units in a word; normally 4.
948
949@findex MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
950@item MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
951Minimum number of units in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
952@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
953smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
954
955@findex POINTER_SIZE
956@item POINTER_SIZE
957Width of a pointer, in bits.  You must specify a value no wider than the
958width of @code{Pmode}.  If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
959you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}.
960
961@findex POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
962@item POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
963A C expression whose value is greater than zero if pointers that need to be
964extended from being @code{POINTER_SIZE} bits wide to @code{Pmode} are to
965be zero-extended and zero if they are to be sign-extended.  If the value
966is less then zero then there must be an "ptr_extend" instruction that
967extends a pointer from @code{POINTER_SIZE} to @code{Pmode}.
968
969You need not define this macro if the @code{POINTER_SIZE} is equal
970to the width of @code{Pmode}.
971
972@findex PROMOTE_MODE
973@item PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
974A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
975is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
976stored in a register.  This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
977scalar type.
978
979On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
980register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
981@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  In most
982cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
983floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
984counterparts.
985
986For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
987However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
988either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes.  For example, on
989the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
990sign-extend the result to 64 bits.  On such machines, set
991@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
992
993Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
994
995@findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
996@item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
997Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
998should also be done for outgoing function arguments.
999
1000@findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
1001@item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
1002Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1003should also be done for the return value of functions.
1004
1005If this macro is defined, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same
1006promotions done by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1007
1008@findex PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1009@item PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1010Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1011should @emph{only} be performed for outgoing function arguments or
1012function return values, as specified by @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS}
1013and @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN}, respectively.
1014
1015@findex PARM_BOUNDARY
1016@item PARM_BOUNDARY
1017Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1018bits.  All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1019regardless of data type.  On most machines, this is the same as the
1020size of an integer.
1021
1022@findex STACK_BOUNDARY
1023@item STACK_BOUNDARY
1024Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
1025stack pointer on this machine.  The definition is a C expression for the
1026desired alignment (measured in bits).  This value is used as a default
1027if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined.  On most machines,
1028this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1029
1030@findex PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1031@item PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1032Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1033stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces.  The definition
1034is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits).  This
1035macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1036@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1037
1038@findex FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
1039@item FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
1040A C expression that evaluates true if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is
1041not guaranteed by the runtime and we should emit code to align the stack
1042at the beginning of @code{main}.
1043
1044@cindex @code{PUSH_ROUNDING}, interaction with @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}
1045If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is not defined, the stack will always be aligned
1046to the specified boundary.  If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is defined and specifies
1047a less strict alignment than @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, the stack may
1048be momentarily unaligned while pushing arguments.
1049
1050@findex FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1051@item FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1052Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1053
1054@findex BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1055@item BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1056Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in bits.
1057
1058@findex MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1059@item MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1060If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1061object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1062nearby object.  Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1063on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1064
1065@findex BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1066@item BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1067Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1068machine, in bits.  If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1069structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1070by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1071
1072@findex ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN
1073@item ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1074An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1075alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1076@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1077alignment) is @var{computed}.  It overrides alignment only if the
1078field alignment has not been set by the
1079@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1080
1081@findex MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1082@item MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1083Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1084Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1085@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.  If not defined,
1086the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1087
1088@findex DATA_ALIGNMENT
1089@item DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1090If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1091the static store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1092the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1093macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1094
1095If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1096
1097@findex strcpy
1098One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1099make it all fit in fewer cache lines.  Another is to cause character
1100arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1101constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1102
1103@findex CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT
1104@item CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1105If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1106that is being placed in memory.  @var{constant} is the constant and
1107@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1108have.  The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1109align the object.
1110
1111If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1112
1113The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1114constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1115constants can be done inline.
1116
1117@findex LOCAL_ALIGNMENT
1118@item LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1119If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1120the local store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1121the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1122macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1123
1124If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1125
1126One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1127make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1128
1129@findex EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1130@item EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1131Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1132empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1133
1134Note that @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} also affects the alignment
1135that results from an empty field.
1136
1137@findex STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1138@item STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1139Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1140Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1141
1142If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1143@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1144
1145@findex STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1146@item STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1147Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1148if given data not on the nominal alignment.  If instructions will merely
1149go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1150
1151@findex PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1152@item PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1153Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1154alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1155
1156The behavior is that the type written for a bit-field (@code{int},
1157@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the
1158entire structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary
1159field of that type.  In addition, the bit-field is placed within the
1160structure so that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a
1161boundary for it.
1162
1163Thus, on most machines, a bit-field whose type is written as @code{int}
1164would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force four-byte
1165alignment for the whole structure.  (The alignment used may not be four
1166bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1167
1168If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1169a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1170
1171Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1172bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary.  The compiler can
1173support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1174@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1175
1176The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1177@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1178Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1179
1180Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1181@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1182@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1183
1184If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1185bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1186what the other compiler does.  Compile and run this program:
1187
1188@example
1189struct foo1
1190@{
1191  char x;
1192  char :0;
1193  char y;
1194@};
1195
1196struct foo2
1197@{
1198  char x;
1199  int :0;
1200  char y;
1201@};
1202
1203main ()
1204@{
1205  printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1206          sizeof (struct foo1));
1207  printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1208          sizeof (struct foo2));
1209  exit (0);
1210@}
1211@end example
1212
1213If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1214get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1215
1216@findex BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1217@item BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1218Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1219to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1220
1221@findex MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK
1222@item MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field})
1223Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1224@code{BLKMODE}.
1225
1226Normally, this is not needed.  See the file @file{c4x.h} for an example
1227of how to use this macro to prevent a structure having a floating point
1228field from being accessed in an integer mode.
1229
1230@findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE
1231@item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1232Define this macro as an expression for the overall size of a type
1233(given by @var{type} as a tree node) when the size computed in the
1234usual way is @var{computed} and the alignment is @var{specified}.
1235
1236The default is to round @var{computed} up to a multiple of @var{specified}.
1237
1238@findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT
1239@item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1240Similar to @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE}, but sizes and alignments are
1241specified in units (bytes).  If you define @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE},
1242you must also define this macro and they must be defined consistently
1243with each other.
1244
1245@findex ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN
1246@item ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1247Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1248by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1249way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1250@var{specified}.
1251
1252The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1253the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1254
1255@findex MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1256@item MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1257An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1258machine mode that should actually be used.  All integer machine modes of
1259this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1260appropriate sizes.  If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1261(DImode)} is assumed.
1262
1263@findex VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
1264@item VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P(@var{mode})
1265Define this macro to be nonzero if the port is prepared to handle insns
1266involving vector mode @var{mode}.  At the very least, it must have move
1267patterns for this mode.
1268
1269@findex STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE
1270@item STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1271If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1272specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1273@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1274@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1275@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1276having its mode specified.
1277
1278You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}.  You
1279would most commonly define this macro if the
1280@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
128164-bit mode.
1282
1283@findex STACK_SIZE_MODE
1284@item STACK_SIZE_MODE
1285If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1286specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1287@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1288
1289You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1290You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1291pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1292
1293@findex CHECK_FLOAT_VALUE
1294@item CHECK_FLOAT_VALUE (@var{mode}, @var{value}, @var{overflow})
1295A C statement to validate the value @var{value} (of type
1296@code{double}) for mode @var{mode}.  This means that you check whether
1297@var{value} fits within the possible range of values for mode
1298@var{mode} on this target machine.  The mode @var{mode} is always
1299a mode of class @code{MODE_FLOAT}.  @var{overflow} is nonzero if
1300the value is already known to be out of range.
1301
1302If @var{value} is not valid or if @var{overflow} is nonzero, you should
1303set @var{overflow} to 1 and then assign some valid value to @var{value}.
1304Allowing an invalid value to go through the compiler can produce
1305incorrect assembler code which may even cause Unix assemblers to crash.
1306
1307This macro need not be defined if there is no work for it to do.
1308
1309@findex TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1310@item TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1311A code distinguishing the floating point format of the target machine.
1312There are five defined values:
1313
1314@table @code
1315@findex IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1316@item IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1317This code indicates IEEE floating point.  It is the default; there is no
1318need to define this macro when the format is IEEE@.
1319
1320@findex VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1321@item VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1322This code indicates the ``D float'' format used on the VAX@.
1323
1324@findex IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1325@item IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1326This code indicates the format used on the IBM System/370.
1327
1328@findex C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1329@item C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1330This code indicates the format used on the TMS320C3x/C4x.
1331
1332@findex UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1333@item UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1334This code indicates any other format.
1335@end table
1336
1337The value of this macro is compared with @code{HOST_FLOAT_FORMAT}, which
1338is defined by the @command{configure} script, to determine whether the
1339target machine has the same format as the host machine.  If any other
1340formats are actually in use on supported machines, new codes should be
1341defined for them.
1342
1343The ordering of the component words of floating point values stored in
1344memory is controlled by @code{FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}.
1345
1346@end table
1347
1348@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (tree @var{record_type})
1349This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1350@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1351Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1352unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1353different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1354alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1355bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1356the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1357(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1358another bit-field of non-zero size.  If this hook returns @code{true},
1359other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1360@end deftypefn
1361
1362@node Type Layout
1363@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1364
1365These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1366basic data types used in programs being compiled.  Unlike the macros in
1367the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1368languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1369
1370@table @code
1371@findex INT_TYPE_SIZE
1372@item INT_TYPE_SIZE
1373A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1374target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1375
1376@findex SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1377@item SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1378A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1379target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1380(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1381unit.)
1382
1383@findex LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1384@item LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1385A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1386target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1387
1388@findex ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1389@item ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1390On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1391@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C.  In
1392that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1393the size of that type.  If you don't define this, the default is the
1394value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1395
1396@findex MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1397@item MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1398Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1399target machine.  If this is undefined, the default is
1400@code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1401largest value that @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.  This is
1402used in @code{cpp}.
1403
1404@findex LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1405@item LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1406A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1407target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1408words.  If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1409macro must be at least 64.
1410
1411@findex CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1412@item CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1413A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1414target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1415@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1416
1417@findex MAX_CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1418@item MAX_CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1419Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1420target machine.  If this is undefined, the default is
1421@code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1422largest value that @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.  This is
1423used in @code{cpp}.
1424
1425@findex BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1426@item BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1427A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1428C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine.  If you don't define
1429this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1430
1431@findex FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1432@item FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1433A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1434target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1435
1436@findex DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1437@item DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1438A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1439target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1440words.
1441
1442@findex LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1443@item LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1444A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1445the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1446words.
1447
1448@findex MAX_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1449Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on the
1450target machine.  If this is undefined, the default is
1451@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is
1452the largest value that @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.
1453This is used in @code{cpp}.
1454
1455@findex INTEL_EXTENDED_IEEE_FORMAT
1456Define this macro to be 1 if the target machine uses 80-bit floating-point
1457values with 128-bit size and alignment.  This is used in @file{real.c}.
1458
1459@findex WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1460@item WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1461A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1462supported by the hardware.  If you define this macro, you must specify a
1463value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1464If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1465is the default.
1466
1467@findex DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1468@item DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1469An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1470@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default.  The user can
1471always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1472and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1473
1474@findex DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1475@item DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1476A C expression to determine whether to give an @code{enum} type
1477only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range of possible values
1478of that type.  A nonzero value means to do that; a zero value means all
1479@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1480
1481If you don't define the macro, the default is 0.
1482
1483@findex SIZE_TYPE
1484@item SIZE_TYPE
1485A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1486for size values.  The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1487contents of the string.
1488
1489The string can contain more than one keyword.  If so, separate them with
1490spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1491appropriate, and finally @code{int}.  The string must exactly match one
1492of the data type names defined in the function
1493@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}.  You may not
1494omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1495crash on startup.
1496
1497If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1498int"}.
1499
1500@findex PTRDIFF_TYPE
1501@item PTRDIFF_TYPE
1502A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1503for the result of subtracting two pointers.  The typedef name
1504@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string.  See
1505@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1506
1507If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1508
1509@findex WCHAR_TYPE
1510@item WCHAR_TYPE
1511A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1512for wide characters.  The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1513the contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1514information.
1515
1516If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1517
1518@findex WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1519@item WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1520A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1521characters.  This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1522@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1523
1524@findex MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1525@item MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1526Maximum number for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1527characters.  If this is undefined, the default is
1528@code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1529largest value that @code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.  This is
1530used in @code{cpp}.
1531
1532@findex GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1533@item GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1534A C expression for the size in bits of the type used for gcov counters on the
1535target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one
1536@code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} in case it is greater or equal to 64-bit and
1537@code{LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE} otherwise.  You may want to re-define the type to
1538ensure atomicity for counters in multithreaded programs.
1539
1540@findex WINT_TYPE
1541@item WINT_TYPE
1542A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1543use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1544@code{getwc}.  The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1545contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1546information.
1547
1548If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1549
1550@findex INTMAX_TYPE
1551@item INTMAX_TYPE
1552A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1553can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1554The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1555string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1556
1557If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1558@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1559much precision as @code{long long int}.
1560
1561@findex UINTMAX_TYPE
1562@item UINTMAX_TYPE
1563A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1564can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1565type.  The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1566of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1567
1568If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1569@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1570unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1571int}.
1572
1573@findex TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1574@item TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1575The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1576that looks like:
1577
1578@example
1579  struct @{
1580    union @{
1581      void (*fn)();
1582      ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1583    @};
1584    ptrdiff_t delta;
1585  @};
1586@end example
1587
1588@noindent
1589The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1590will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1591Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1592always be zero.  Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1593distinguish which variant of the union is in use.  But, on some
1594platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work.  In
1595that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1596the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1597
1598GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1599this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1600However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1601set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1602bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1603address is in ARM or Thumb mode.  If this is the case of your
1604architecture, you should define this macro to
1605@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1606
1607In general, you should not have to define this macro.  On architectures
1608in which function addresses are always even, according to
1609@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1610@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1611
1612@findex TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1613@item TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1614Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables.  This
1615macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1616instead.  Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1617function pointer is actually a small data structure.  Normally the
1618data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1619pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1620
1621If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1622of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1623@end table
1624
1625@node Escape Sequences
1626@section Target Character Escape Sequences
1627@cindex escape sequences
1628
1629By default, GCC assumes that the C character escape sequences take on
1630their ASCII values for the target.  If this is not correct, you must
1631explicitly define all of the macros below.
1632
1633@table @code
1634@findex TARGET_BELL
1635@item TARGET_BELL
1636A C constant expression for the integer value for escape sequence
1637@samp{\a}.
1638
1639@findex TARGET_ESC
1640@item TARGET_ESC
1641A C constant expression for the integer value of the target escape
1642character.  As an extension, GCC evaluates the escape sequences
1643@samp{\e} and @samp{\E} to this.
1644
1645@findex TARGET_TAB
1646@findex TARGET_BS
1647@findex TARGET_NEWLINE
1648@item TARGET_BS
1649@itemx TARGET_TAB
1650@itemx TARGET_NEWLINE
1651C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1652@samp{\b}, @samp{\t} and @samp{\n}.
1653
1654@findex TARGET_VT
1655@findex TARGET_FF
1656@findex TARGET_CR
1657@item TARGET_VT
1658@itemx TARGET_FF
1659@itemx TARGET_CR
1660C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1661@samp{\v}, @samp{\f} and @samp{\r}.
1662@end table
1663
1664@node Registers
1665@section Register Usage
1666@cindex register usage
1667
1668This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1669has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1670
1671The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1672done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}.  For information
1673on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1674For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1675For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1676
1677@menu
1678* Register Basics::		Number and kinds of registers.
1679* Allocation Order::		Order in which registers are allocated.
1680* Values in Registers::		What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1681* Leaf Functions::		Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1682* Stack Registers::		Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1683@end menu
1684
1685@node Register Basics
1686@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1687
1688@c prevent bad page break with this line
1689Registers have various characteristics.
1690
1691@table @code
1692@findex FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1693@item FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1694Number of hardware registers known to the compiler.  They receive
1695numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1696pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1697@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1698
1699@item FIXED_REGISTERS
1700@findex FIXED_REGISTERS
1701@cindex fixed register
1702An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1703all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1704general allocation.  These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1705pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1706register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1707machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1708and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1709
1710This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1711commas and surrounded by braces.  The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1712register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1713
1714The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1715the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1716by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1717the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1718@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1719
1720@findex CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1721@item CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1722@cindex call-used register
1723@cindex call-clobbered register
1724@cindex call-saved register
1725Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1726clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1727registers.  This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1728available for general allocation of values that must live across
1729function calls.
1730
1731If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1732automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1733exit, if the register is used within the function.
1734
1735@findex CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1736@item CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1737@cindex call-used register
1738@cindex call-clobbered register
1739@cindex call-saved register
1740Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1741that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1742(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1743This macro is optional.  If not specified, it defaults to the value
1744of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1745
1746@findex HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED
1747@item HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1748@cindex call-used register
1749@cindex call-clobbered register
1750@cindex call-saved register
1751A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1752value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1753call without some part of it being clobbered.  For most machines this
1754macro need not be defined.  It is only required for machines that do not
1755preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1756
1757@findex CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1758@findex fixed_regs
1759@findex call_used_regs
1760@item CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1761Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1762@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1763@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1764any dependence of these register sets on target flags.  The first three
1765of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1766@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1767@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}.  Before the macro is
1768called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1769@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1770from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1771@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1772@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1773@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1774command options have been applied.
1775
1776You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1777
1778@cindex disabling certain registers
1779@cindex controlling register usage
1780If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1781flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1782@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1783registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@.  Also define
1784the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1785is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1786
1787(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1788of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1789controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1790these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1791
1792@findex NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1793@item NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1794If this macro is defined and has a nonzero value, it means that
1795@code{setjmp} and related functions fail to save the registers, or that
1796@code{longjmp} fails to restore them.  To compensate, the compiler
1797avoids putting variables in registers in functions that use
1798@code{setjmp}.
1799
1800@findex INCOMING_REGNO
1801@item INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1802Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1803expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1804corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1805function.  Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1806outbound register.
1807
1808@findex OUTGOING_REGNO
1809@item OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1810Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1811expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1812corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1813function.  Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1814register.
1815
1816@findex LOCAL_REGNO
1817@item LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1818Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1819expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1820register window.  Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1821need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1822gotos.
1823
1824@ignore
1825@findex PC_REGNUM
1826@item PC_REGNUM
1827If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1828register number.  Otherwise, do not define it.
1829@end ignore
1830@end table
1831
1832@node Allocation Order
1833@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1834@cindex order of register allocation
1835@cindex register allocation order
1836
1837@c prevent bad page break with this line
1838Registers are allocated in order.
1839
1840@table @code
1841@findex REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1842@item REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1843If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1844numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1845to use them (from most preferred to least).
1846
1847If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1848(all else being equal).
1849
1850One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1851registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1852instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers.  On such
1853machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1854the highest numbered allocable register first.
1855
1856@findex ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1857@item ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1858A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1859hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1860
1861Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1862Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1863register; and so on.
1864
1865The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1866@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1867
1868On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1869@end table
1870
1871@node Values in Registers
1872@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
1873
1874This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
1875(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
1876consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
1877
1878@table @code
1879@findex HARD_REGNO_NREGS
1880@item HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1881A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
1882at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
1883@var{mode}.
1884
1885On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
1886definition of this macro is
1887
1888@smallexample
1889#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE)            \
1890   ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)  \
1891    / UNITS_PER_WORD)
1892@end smallexample
1893
1894@findex HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
1895@item HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1896A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
1897of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
1898registers starting with that one).  For a machine where all registers
1899are equivalent, a suitable definition is
1900
1901@smallexample
1902#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
1903@end smallexample
1904
1905You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
1906because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
1907
1908@cindex register pairs
1909On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
1910register pairs.  You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
1911odd register numbers for such modes.
1912
1913The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
1914@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
1915register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
1916value into the register and back out not alter it.
1917
1918Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
1919all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
1920@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
1921you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this.  This
1922is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
1923and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
1924to be tieable.
1925
1926Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
1927Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
1928in floating point registers.  This is not true.  Any registers that
1929can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
1930mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
1931registers.  Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
1932
1933On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
1934modes may not go in floating registers.  This is true if the floating
1935registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
1936non-floating value there would garble it.  In this case,
1937@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
1938floating registers.  But if the floating registers do not automatically
1939normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
1940unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
1941register, so you can define this macro to say so.
1942
1943The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
1944they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
1945instructions.  However, this is of no concern to
1946@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.  You handle it by writing the proper
1947constraints for those instructions.
1948
1949On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
1950so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
1951register if floating point arithmetic is not being done.  As long as the
1952floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
1953be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
1954
1955@findex MODES_TIEABLE_P
1956@item MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
1957A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
1958@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
1959
1960If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
1961@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
1962any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
1963should be nonzero.  If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
1964this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
1965accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
1966
1967You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
1968possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
1969allocation.
1970
1971@findex AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
1972@item AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
1973Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
1974registers.  You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
1975@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
1976@end table
1977
1978@node Leaf Functions
1979@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
1980
1981@cindex leaf functions
1982@cindex functions, leaf
1983On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
1984more efficiently if it does not make its own register window.  Often this
1985means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
1986are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
1987normally arrive.
1988
1989The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
1990other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
1991registers for its own variables and temporaries.  We use the term ``leaf
1992function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
1993handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
1994functions''.
1995
1996GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
1997suitable for leaf function treatment.  So it needs to renumber the
1998registers in order to output a leaf function.  The following macros
1999accomplish this.
2000
2001@table @code
2002@findex LEAF_REGISTERS
2003@item LEAF_REGISTERS
2004Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2005contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2006function treatment.
2007
2008If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2009registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2010GCC would ordinarily allocate.  The registers which will actually be
2011used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2012in this vector.
2013
2014Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2015the treatment of leaf functions.
2016
2017@findex LEAF_REG_REMAP
2018@item LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2019A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2020should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2021
2022If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2023function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2024will cause the compiler to abort.
2025
2026Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2027treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2028this.
2029@end table
2030
2031@findex current_function_is_leaf
2032@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2033@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2034@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2035specially.  They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2036which is nonzero for leaf functions.  @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2037set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2038compiler passes.  They can also test the C variable
2039@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2040functions which only use leaf registers.
2041@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after reload and is
2042only useful if @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2043@c changed this to fix overfull.  ALSO:  why the "it" at the beginning
2044@c of the next paragraph?!  --mew 2feb93
2045
2046@node Stack Registers
2047@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2048
2049There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2050``registers'' form a stack, as in the 80387 coprocessor for the 80386.
2051Stack registers are normally written by pushing onto the stack, and are
2052numbered relative to the top of the stack.
2053
2054Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2055they must be consecutively numbered.
2056
2057@table @code
2058@findex STACK_REGS
2059@item STACK_REGS
2060Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2061
2062@findex FIRST_STACK_REG
2063@item FIRST_STACK_REG
2064The number of the first stack-like register.  This one is the top
2065of the stack.
2066
2067@findex LAST_STACK_REG
2068@item LAST_STACK_REG
2069The number of the last stack-like register.  This one is the bottom of
2070the stack.
2071@end table
2072
2073@node Register Classes
2074@section Register Classes
2075@cindex register class definitions
2076@cindex class definitions, register
2077
2078On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2079For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2080certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions.  These machine
2081restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2082
2083You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2084which of the registers belong to it.  Then you can specify register classes
2085that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2086
2087@findex ALL_REGS
2088@findex NO_REGS
2089In general, each register will belong to several classes.  In fact, one
2090class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers.  Another
2091class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers.  Often the
2092union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2093
2094@findex GENERAL_REGS
2095One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  There is nothing
2096terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2097@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class.  If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2098the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2099to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2100
2101Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2102then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2103
2104The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2105constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2106You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2107them in operand constraints.
2108
2109You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2110instruction allows both classes.  For example, if an instruction allows
2111either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2112certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2113which includes both of them.  Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2114
2115You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2116classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2117contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2118in their union.
2119
2120When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2121certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2122Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2123a register pair to start with an even-numbered register.  The way to
2124specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2125
2126Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2127instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2128each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2129mode to or from memory.  For example, on some machines, the operations for
2130single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers.  When
2131this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2132instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2133single-byte values can be loaded or stored.  This is so that
2134@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2135
2136@table @code
2137@findex enum reg_class
2138@item enum reg_class
2139An enumeral type that must be defined with all the register class names
2140as enumeral values.  @code{NO_REGS} must be first.  @code{ALL_REGS}
2141must be the last register class, followed by one more enumeral value,
2142@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2143tells how many classes there are.
2144
2145Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2146the class name to type @code{int}.  The number serves as an index
2147in many of the tables described below.
2148
2149@findex N_REG_CLASSES
2150@item N_REG_CLASSES
2151The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2152
2153@example
2154#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2155@end example
2156
2157@findex REG_CLASS_NAMES
2158@item REG_CLASS_NAMES
2159An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2160constants.  These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2161
2162@findex REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2163@item REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2164An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2165which are bit masks.  The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2166@var{n}.  The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2167register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2168
2169When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2170Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2171several integers.  Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2172for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2173In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2174registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2175so on.
2176
2177@findex REGNO_REG_CLASS
2178@item REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2179A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2180@var{regno}.  In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2181which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2182register.
2183
2184@findex BASE_REG_CLASS
2185@item BASE_REG_CLASS
2186A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2187base register must belong.  A base register is one used in an address
2188which is the register value plus a displacement.
2189
2190@findex MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS
2191@item MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2192This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2193the selection of a base register in a mode depenedent manner.  If
2194@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2195@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2196
2197@findex INDEX_REG_CLASS
2198@item INDEX_REG_CLASS
2199A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2200index register must belong.  An index register is one used in an
2201address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2202added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2203
2204@findex REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER
2205@item REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2206A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2207letters for register classes.  If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2208value should be the register class corresponding to it.  Otherwise,
2209the value should be @code{NO_REGS}.  The register letter @samp{r},
2210corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2211to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2212
2213@findex REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2214@item REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2215A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2216suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.  It may be
2217either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2218allocated such a hard register.
2219
2220@findex REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2221@item REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2222A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2223that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2224@var{mode}.  You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2225reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register.  If
2226you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2227@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2228
2229@findex REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
2230@item REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2231A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2232suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses.  It may be
2233either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2234allocated such a hard register.
2235
2236The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2237the index register may be scaled.  If an address involves the sum of
2238two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2239labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2240labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2241may serve in each capacity.  The compiler will try both labelings,
2242looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2243only if neither labeling works.
2244
2245@findex PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2246@item PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2247A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2248to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2249@var{class}.  The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2250another, smaller class.  On many machines, the following definition is
2251safe:
2252
2253@example
2254#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2255@end example
2256
2257Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code.  For
2258example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2259for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2260@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2261Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2262
2263If @var{x} is a @code{const_double}, by returning @code{NO_REGS}
2264you can force @var{x} into a memory constant.  This is useful on
2265certain machines where immediate floating values cannot be loaded into
2266certain kinds of registers.
2267
2268@findex PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2269@item PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2270Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2271input reloads.  If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2272@var{class}, unchanged.
2273
2274@findex LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS
2275@item LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2276A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2277to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2278@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2279ordinarily be used.
2280
2281Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2282there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2283
2284The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2285smaller class.
2286
2287Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2288require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2289
2290@findex SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS
2291@findex SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2292@findex SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2293@item SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2294@itemx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2295@itemx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2296Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2297from memory or even from other types of registers.  An example is the
2298@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2299from general registers, but not memory.  Some machines allow copying all
2300registers to and from memory, but require a scratch register for stores
2301to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic address on the RT,
2302and those with certain symbolic address on the Sparc when compiling
2303PIC)@.  In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are
2304required.
2305
2306You should define these macros to indicate to the reload phase that it may
2307need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2308register to contain the data.  Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2309register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2310you should define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2311largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2312intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2313
2314If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2315intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2316should be defined to return the largest register class required.  If the
2317requirements for input and output reloads are the same, the macro
2318@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should be used instead of defining both
2319macros identically.
2320
2321The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2322Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2323can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2324@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register.  Do not define this
2325macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2326
2327If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2328intermediate register), you should define patterns for
2329@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2330(@pxref{Standard Names}.  These patterns, which will normally be
2331implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2332@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2333register.
2334
2335Define constraints for the reload register and scratch register that
2336contain a single register class.  If the original reload register (whose
2337class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2338value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2339register.  Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2340Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2341
2342@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2343pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2344Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2345in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2346
2347These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2348registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2349registers.  In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2350would not be helpful.  Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2351the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2352intermediate storage.  This case often occurs between floating-point and
2353general registers.
2354
2355@findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
2356@item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2357Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2358to some other registers without using memory.  Define this macro on
2359those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2360@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2361class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2362and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2363
2364Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2365
2366@findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX
2367@item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2368Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2369allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2370If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2371defined by this macro.
2372
2373Do not define this macro if you do not define
2374@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2375
2376@findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE
2377@item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2378When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2379registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2380hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2381load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2382same as that of @var{mode}.
2383
2384This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2385bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2386in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2387registers.
2388
2389However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2390the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2391differently than in integer registers.  On those machines, the default
2392widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2393suppress that widening in some cases.  See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2394details.
2395
2396Do not define this macro if you do not define
2397@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2398is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2399
2400@findex SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2401@item SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2402On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
2403insns.  Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
2404to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
2405if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
2406insn.
2407
2408Define @code{SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES} to be an expression with a nonzero
2409value on these machines.  When this macro has a nonzero value, the
2410compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of hard registers.
2411
2412It is always safe to define this macro with a nonzero value, but if you
2413unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
2414that can be performed in some cases.  If you do not define this macro
2415with a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out of
2416spill registers and print a fatal error message.  For most machines, you
2417should not define this macro at all.
2418
2419@findex CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2420@item CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (@var{class})
2421A C expression whose value is nonzero if pseudos that have been assigned
2422to registers of class @var{class} would likely be spilled because
2423registers of @var{class} are needed for spill registers.
2424
2425The default value of this macro returns 1 if @var{class} has exactly one
2426register and zero otherwise.  On most machines, this default should be
2427used.  Only define this macro to some other expression if pseudos
2428allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their hard
2429registers were needed for spill registers.  If this macro returns nonzero
2430for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2431@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2432register.  If there would not be another register available for
2433reallocation, you should not change the definition of this macro since
2434the only effect of such a definition would be to slow down register
2435allocation.
2436
2437@findex CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2438@item CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2439A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2440of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2441
2442This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.  In fact,
2443the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2444should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2445@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2446
2447This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2448in the reload pass.
2449
2450@item CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE
2451If defined, a C expression for a class that contains registers for
2452which the compiler may not change modes arbitrarily.
2453
2454@item CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P(@var{from}, @var{to})
2455A C expression that is true if, for a register in
2456@code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE}, the requested mode punning is invalid.
2457
2458For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2459floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2460Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2461does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2462register.  Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE}
2463as @code{FLOAT_REGS} and @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P} restricts
2464mode changes to same-size modes.
2465
2466Compare this to IA-64, which extends floating-point values to 82 bits,
2467and stores 64-bit integers in a different format than 64-bit doubles.
2468Therefore @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P} is always true.
2469@end table
2470
2471Three other special macros describe which operands fit which constraint
2472letters.
2473
2474@table @code
2475@findex CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2476@item CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2477A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2478letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2479particular ranges of integer values.  If @var{c} is one of those
2480letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2481the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise.  If @var{c} is
2482not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2483@var{value}.
2484
2485@findex CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2486@item CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2487A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2488letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2489(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2490
2491If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2492@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2493range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise.  If @var{c} is not one of those
2494letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2495
2496@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2497@code{DImode} fixed-point constants.  A given letter can accept either
2498or both kinds of values.  It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2499between these kinds.
2500
2501@findex EXTRA_CONSTRAINT
2502@item EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2503A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2504letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2505memory references, for the target machine.  Any letter that is not
2506elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}
2507may be used.  Normally this macro will not be defined.
2508
2509If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2510if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2511constraint letter @var{c}.  If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2512constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2513
2514For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2515in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address.  Constraint
2516letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2517@emph{not} contain a symbolic address.  An alternative is specified with
2518a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output.  The next
2519alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2520does not include r0 on the output.
2521@end table
2522
2523@node Stack and Calling
2524@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2525@cindex calling conventions
2526
2527@c prevent bad page break with this line
2528This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2529
2530@menu
2531* Frame Layout::
2532* Exception Handling::
2533* Stack Checking::
2534* Frame Registers::
2535* Elimination::
2536* Stack Arguments::
2537* Register Arguments::
2538* Scalar Return::
2539* Aggregate Return::
2540* Caller Saves::
2541* Function Entry::
2542* Profiling::
2543* Tail Calls::
2544@end menu
2545
2546@node Frame Layout
2547@subsection Basic Stack Layout
2548@cindex stack frame layout
2549@cindex frame layout
2550
2551@c prevent bad page break with this line
2552Here is the basic stack layout.
2553
2554@table @code
2555@findex STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2556@item STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2557Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2558pointer to a smaller address.
2559
2560When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{},'' it means that the
2561compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
2562definition used does not matter.
2563
2564@findex STACK_PUSH_CODE
2565@item STACK_PUSH_CODE
2566
2567This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2568on the stack.  In RTL, a push operation will be
2569@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) ...)}
2570
2571The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2572and @code{POST_INC}.  Which of these is correct depends on
2573the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2574to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2575space for the next item on the stack.
2576
2577The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2578defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2579which is often wrong.
2580
2581@findex FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2582@item FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2583Define this macro if the addresses of local variable slots are at negative
2584offsets from the frame pointer.
2585
2586@findex ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2587@item ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2588Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2589addresses on the stack.
2590
2591@findex STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2592@item STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2593Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2594
2595If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2596subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2597Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2598value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2599@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2600@c rid of an overfull.  --mew 2feb93
2601
2602@findex STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2603@item STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2604Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2605outgoing arguments are placed.  If not specified, the default value of
2606zero is used.  This is the proper value for most machines.
2607
2608If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2609the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2610
2611@findex FIRST_PARM_OFFSET
2612@item FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2613Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
2614address.  On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
2615function.
2616
2617If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2618the first argument's address.
2619
2620@findex STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET
2621@item STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2622Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
2623on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
2624
2625The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
2626length of the outgoing arguments.  The default is correct for most
2627machines.  See @file{function.c} for details.
2628
2629@findex DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS
2630@item DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
2631A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
2632frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored.  Assume that
2633@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
2634itself.
2635
2636If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
2637of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
2638address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
2639
2640@findex SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2641@item SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2642If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
2643setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed.  For example,
2644on the Sparc, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
2645before we can access arbitrary stack frames.  You will seldom need to
2646define this macro.
2647
2648@findex BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2649@item BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2650If defined, a C expression that contains an rtx that is used to store
2651the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
2652The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
2653machines.  One reason you may need to define this macro is if
2654@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
2655
2656@findex RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2657@item RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
2658A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
2659address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
2660the prologue.  @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
2661frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
2662@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
2663
2664The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
2665@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is not way to
2666determine the return address of other frames.
2667
2668@findex RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2669@item RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2670Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
2671from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
2672
2673@findex INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2674@item INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2675A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
2676incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
2677prologue.  This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
2678value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
2679the stack.
2680
2681You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2682debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2683
2684If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
2685@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
2686
2687@findex INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2688@item INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2689A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2690from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
2691frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue.  The top of
2692the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
2693previous frame, just before the call instruction.
2694
2695You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2696debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2697
2698@findex ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
2699@item ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2700A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2701from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).  The
2702final value should coincide with that calculated by
2703@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.  Which is unfortunately not usable
2704during virtual register instantiation.
2705
2706The default value for this macro is @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl)},
2707which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
2708immediately before the stack frame.  Note that this is not the case on
2709some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
2710and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2711
2712You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2713want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
2714DWARF 2.
2715
2716@findex SMALL_STACK
2717@item SMALL_STACK
2718Define this macro if the stack size for the target is very small.  This
2719has the effect of disabling gcc's built-in @samp{alloca}, though
2720@samp{__builtin_alloca} is not affected.
2721@end table
2722
2723@node Exception Handling
2724@subsection Exception Handling Support
2725@cindex exception handling
2726
2727@table @code
2728@findex EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO
2729@item EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
2730A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
2731data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
2732@var{N} registers are usable.
2733
2734The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
2735handlers via a set of agreed upon registers.  Ideally these registers
2736should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
2737but may negatively impact code size.  The target must support at least
27382 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
2739
2740You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2741handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2742
2743@findex EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2744@item EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2745A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2746to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
2747This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
2748It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
2749
2750Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
2751untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
2752
2753You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2754handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2755
2756@findex EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2757@item EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2758A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2759to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
2760return.  It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
2761
2762Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
2763return address is stored.  For targets that return by popping an
2764address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
2765the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
2766frame.  @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already been assigned,
2767so it may be used to calculate the location of the target call frame.
2768
2769Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
2770address calculable during initial code generation.  In that case
2771the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
2772
2773If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
2774define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
2775
2776@findex ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT
2777@item ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT(@var{code}, @var{global})
2778This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
2779handling sections.  If at all possible, this should be defined such
2780that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
2781and so may be read-only.
2782
2783@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
2784@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
2785The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
2786as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
2787
2788If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
2789represented directly.
2790
2791@findex ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX
2792@item ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX(@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
2793This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
2794to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
2795Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
2796be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
2797
2798This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
2799handled.  @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
2800of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
2801to be emitted.
2802
2803@findex MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR
2804@item MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR(@var{context}, @var{fs}, @var{success})
2805This macro allows the target to add cpu and operating system specific
2806code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
2807available.  The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
2808through signal frames.
2809
2810This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in @file{unwind-dw2.c}
2811and @file{unwind-ia64.c}.  @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
2812@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}.  Examine @code{context->ra}
2813for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
2814the stack pointer value.  If the frame can be decoded, the register save
2815addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should branch to
2816@var{success}.  If the frame cannot be decoded, the macro should do
2817nothing.
2818@end table
2819
2820@node Stack Checking
2821@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
2822
2823GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of
2824the stack, if the @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of three ways:
2825
2826@enumerate
2827@item
2828If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
2829will assume that you have arranged for stack checking to be done at
2830appropriate places in the configuration files, e.g., in
2831@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}.  GCC will do not other special
2832processing.
2833
2834@item
2835If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and you defined a named pattern
2836called @code{check_stack} in your @file{md} file, GCC will call that
2837pattern with one argument which is the address to compare the stack
2838value against.  You must arrange for this pattern to report an error if
2839the stack pointer is out of range.
2840
2841@item
2842If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
2843``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
2844@end enumerate
2845
2846Normally, you will use the default values of these macros, so GCC
2847will use the third approach.
2848
2849@table @code
2850@findex STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
2851@item STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
2852A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
2853machine-dependent manner.  You should define this macro if stack checking
2854is require by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to have to stack
2855checking in some more efficient way than GCC's portable approach.
2856The default value of this macro is zero.
2857
2858@findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
2859@item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
2860An integer representing the interval at which GCC must generate stack
2861probe instructions.  You will normally define this macro to be no larger
2862than the size of the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area.  The
2863default value of 4096 is suitable for most systems.
2864
2865@findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
2866@item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
2867A integer which is nonzero if GCC should perform the stack probe
2868as a load instruction and zero if GCC should use a store instruction.
2869The default is zero, which is the most efficient choice on most systems.
2870
2871@findex STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
2872@item STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
2873The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow,
2874for languages where such a recovery is supported.  The default value of
287575 words should be adequate for most machines.
2876
2877@findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
2878@item STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
2879The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes.  GCC will generate probe
2880instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
2881stack are available.  If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
2882checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning.  The
2883default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
2884systems.  You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
2885
2886@findex STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
2887@item STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
2888GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message.  It
2889represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
2890space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
2891You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
2892use the default of four words.
2893
2894@findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
2895@item STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
2896The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
2897fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
2898@option{-fstack-check}.
2899GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
2900normally not need to override that default.
2901@end table
2902
2903@need 2000
2904@node Frame Registers
2905@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
2906
2907@c prevent bad page break with this line
2908This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
2909
2910@table @code
2911@findex STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2912@item STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2913The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
2914fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}.  On most machines,
2915the hardware determines which register this is.
2916
2917@findex FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2918@item FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2919The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
2920access automatic variables in the stack frame.  On some machines, the
2921hardware determines which register this is.  On other machines, you can
2922choose any register you wish for this purpose.
2923
2924@findex HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2925@item HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2926On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
2927offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
2928allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
2929between these two locations).  On those machines, define
2930@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
2931be used internally until the offset is known, and define
2932@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
2933used for the frame pointer.
2934
2935You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
2936is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
2937the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
2938completed.  When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
2939definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
2940@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
2941or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
2942
2943Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
2944@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
2945
2946@findex ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
2947@item ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
2948The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
2949the function's argument list.  On some machines, this is the same as the
2950frame pointer register.  On some machines, the hardware determines which
2951register this is.  On other machines, you can choose any register you
2952wish for this purpose.  If this is not the same register as the frame
2953pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
2954@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
2955(@pxref{Elimination}).
2956
2957@findex RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
2958@item RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
2959The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
2960access the current function's return address from the stack.  On some
2961machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
2962pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer.  This register can be defined
2963to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
2964@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
2965
2966Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
2967address from the stack.
2968
2969@findex STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
2970@findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
2971@item STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
2972@itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
2973Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer.  If
2974register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
2975function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
2976number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}.  If
2977these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
2978not be defined.
2979
2980The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
2981
2982If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
2983defined; instead, the next two macros should be defined.
2984
2985@findex STATIC_CHAIN
2986@findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
2987@item STATIC_CHAIN
2988@itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
2989If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros provide rtx giving
2990@code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
2991@code{STATIC_CHAIN} and @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING} give the locations
2992as seen by the calling and called functions, respectively.  Often the former
2993will be at an offset from the stack pointer and the latter at an offset from
2994the frame pointer.
2995
2996@findex stack_pointer_rtx
2997@findex frame_pointer_rtx
2998@findex arg_pointer_rtx
2999The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3000@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized prior to the use of these
3001macros and should be used to refer to those items.
3002
3003If the static chain is passed in a register, the two previous macros should
3004be defined instead.
3005
3006@findex DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3007@item DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3008This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3009saved in a call frame.  This is used to size data structures used in
3010DWARF2 exception handling.
3011
3012Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3013exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3014extensions.  In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3015in the number of hard registers.  Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3016used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3017routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3018registers that are not call-saved.
3019
3020If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3021@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3022
3023@findex PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3024@item PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3025
3026This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3027for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3028
3029If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3030@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3031
3032@end table
3033
3034@node Elimination
3035@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3036
3037@c prevent bad page break with this line
3038This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3039
3040@table @code
3041@findex FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3042@item FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3043A C expression which is nonzero if a function must have and use a frame
3044pointer.  This expression is evaluated  in the reload pass.  If its value is
3045nonzero the function will have a frame pointer.
3046
3047The expression can in principle examine the current function and decide
3048according to the facts, but on most machines the constant 0 or the
3049constant 1 suffices.  Use 0 when the machine allows code to be generated
3050with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.  Use 1
3051when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame pointer.
3052
3053In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3054without a frame pointer.  The compiler recognizes those cases and
3055automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3056@code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} says.  You don't need to worry about
3057them.
3058
3059In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3060register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3061fixed register.  See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3062
3063@findex INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET
3064@findex get_frame_size
3065@item INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3066A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3067between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3068the function prologue.  The value would be computed from information
3069such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3070registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3071
3072If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3073need not be defined.  Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3074@code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} is defined to always be true; in that
3075case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3076
3077@findex ELIMINABLE_REGS
3078@item ELIMINABLE_REGS
3079If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3080eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.  If it is not
3081defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3082references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3083
3084The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3085of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3086
3087On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3088the compilation is completed.  In such a case, a separate hard register
3089must be used for the argument pointer.  This register can be eliminated by
3090replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3091depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3092
3093In this case, you might specify:
3094@example
3095#define ELIMINABLE_REGS  \
3096@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3097 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3098 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3099@end example
3100
3101Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3102specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3103
3104@findex CAN_ELIMINATE
3105@item CAN_ELIMINATE (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg})
3106A C expression that returns nonzero if the compiler is allowed to try
3107to replace register number @var{from-reg} with register number
3108@var{to-reg}.  This macro need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3109is defined, and will usually be the constant 1, since most of the cases
3110preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3111knows about.
3112
3113@findex INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET
3114@item INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3115This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}.  It
3116specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3117registers.  This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3118defined.
3119@end table
3120
3121@node Stack Arguments
3122@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3123@cindex arguments on stack
3124@cindex stack arguments
3125
3126The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3127on the stack.  See the following section for other macros that
3128control passing certain arguments in registers.
3129
3130@table @code
3131@findex PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3132@item PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3133A C expression whose value is nonzero if an argument declared in
3134a prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should
3135actually be passed as an @code{int}.  In addition to avoiding
3136errors in certain cases of mismatch, it also makes for better
3137code on certain machines.  If the macro is not defined in target
3138header files, it defaults to 0.
3139
3140@findex PUSH_ARGS
3141@item PUSH_ARGS
3142A C expression.  If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3143outgoing arguments.
3144If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3145That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3146allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3147it.  When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3148
3149@findex PUSH_ROUNDING
3150@item PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3151A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3152stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3153
3154On some machines, the definition
3155
3156@example
3157#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3158@end example
3159
3160@noindent
3161will suffice.  But on other machines, instructions that appear
3162to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3163alignment.  Then the definition should be
3164
3165@example
3166#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3167@end example
3168
3169@findex ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3170@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3171@item ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3172A C expression.  If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3173will be computed and placed into the variable
3174@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.  No space will be pushed
3175onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3176increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3177
3178Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3179is not proper.
3180
3181@findex REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3182@item REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3183Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3184allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3185registers.
3186
3187The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3188arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3189which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3190
3191This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3192machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3193which.
3194@c above is overfull.  not sure what to do.  --mew 5feb93  did
3195@c something, not sure if it looks good.  --mew 10feb93
3196
3197@findex MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3198@findex FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3199@item MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3200@itemx FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{const_size}, @var{var_size})
3201Define these macros in addition to the one above if functions might
3202allocate stack space for arguments even when their values are passed
3203in registers.  These should be used when the stack space allocated
3204for arguments in registers is not a simple constant independent of the
3205function declaration.
3206
3207The value of the first macro is the size, in bytes, of the area that
3208we should initially assume would be reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3209
3210The value of the second macro is the actual size, in bytes, of the area
3211that will be reserved for arguments passed in registers.  This takes two
3212arguments: an integer representing the number of bytes of fixed sized
3213arguments on the stack, and a tree representing the number of bytes of
3214variable sized arguments on the stack.
3215
3216When these macros are defined, @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} will only be
3217called for libcall functions, the current function, or for a function
3218being called when it is known that such stack space must be allocated.
3219In each case this value can be easily computed.
3220
3221When deciding whether a called function needs such stack space, and how
3222much space to reserve, GCC uses these two macros instead of
3223@code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}.
3224
3225@findex OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3226@item OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3227Define this if it is the responsibility of the caller to allocate the area
3228reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3229
3230If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3231whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3232@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3233
3234@findex STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3235@item STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3236Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3237stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3238@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3239@c overfull.. not as specific, tho.  --mew 5feb93
3240
3241Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3242stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area.  Defining this macro
3243suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3244stack in its natural location.
3245
3246@findex RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3247@item RETURN_POPS_ARGS (@var{fundecl}, @var{funtype}, @var{stack-size})
3248A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes of its own
3249arguments that a function pops on returning, or 0 if the
3250function pops no arguments and the caller must therefore pop them all
3251after the function returns.
3252
3253@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3254the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3255@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3256From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3257
3258@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3259describes the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3260@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3261From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3262arguments (if known).
3263
3264When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3265will contain an identifier node for the library function.  Thus, if
3266you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3267by their names.  Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3268a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3269in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3270
3271@var{stack-size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3272stack.  If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3273argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3274
3275On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3276of this macro is @var{stack-size}.  On the 68000, using the standard
3277calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3278the macro is always 0 in this case.  But an alternative calling
3279convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3280arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3281nothing (the caller pops all).  When this convention is in use,
3282@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3283number of arguments.
3284
3285@findex CALL_POPS_ARGS
3286@item   CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3287A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3288pops off the stack.  It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3289when compiling a function call.
3290
3291@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3292have been accumulated.
3293
3294On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3295that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3296that have been passed to the function.  Since this is a property of the
3297call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3298appropriate.
3299
3300@end table
3301
3302@node Register Arguments
3303@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3304@cindex arguments in registers
3305@cindex registers arguments
3306
3307This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3308types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3309the stack.
3310
3311@table @code
3312@findex FUNCTION_ARG
3313@item FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3314A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3315in a register, and which register.
3316
3317The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3318arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3319the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3320(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3321which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3322correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3323@var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3324occurred.
3325
3326The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3327hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3328argument on the stack.
3329
3330For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
3331pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3332
3333The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@.  This is
3334used when an argument is passed in multiple locations.  The mode of the
3335of the @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument.  The
3336@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3337describes where part of the argument is passed.  In each
3338@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3339register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3340register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is.  The
3341second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3342the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3343As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3344RTX may have a first operand of zero.  This indicates that the entire
3345argument is also stored on the stack.
3346
3347The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3348VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3349pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3350
3351@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3352The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
3353where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
3354nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead.  This is done
3355by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
3356
3357@cindex @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3358@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3359You may use the macro @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})}
3360in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3361type that must be passed in the stack.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3362is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3363argument, the compiler will abort.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3364defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3365a register.
3366
3367@findex MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
3368@item MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3369Define as a C expression that evaluates to nonzero if we do not know how
3370to pass TYPE solely in registers.  The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3371definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3372documentation.
3373
3374@findex FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
3375@item FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3376Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
3377that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3378necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3379argument.
3380
3381For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
3382the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
3383be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
3384where the arguments will arrive.
3385
3386If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3387serves both purposes.
3388
3389@findex FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS
3390@item FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3391A C expression for the number of words, at the beginning of an
3392argument, that must be put in registers.  The value must be zero for
3393arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3394pushed on the stack.
3395
3396On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3397registers and partially in memory.  On these machines, typically the
3398first @var{n} words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3399on the stack.  If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3400structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3401in registers and the rest must be pushed.  This macro tells the
3402compiler when this occurs, and how many of the words should go in
3403registers.
3404
3405@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3406register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3407@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3408
3409@findex FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
3410@item FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3411A C expression that indicates when an argument must be passed by reference.
3412If nonzero for an argument, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3413pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3414The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3415to that type.
3416
3417On machines where @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is not defined, a suitable
3418definition of this macro might be
3419@smallexample
3420#define FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE\
3421(CUM, MODE, TYPE, NAMED)  \
3422  MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (MODE, TYPE)
3423@end smallexample
3424@c this is *still* too long.  --mew 5feb93
3425
3426@findex FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES
3427@item FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3428If defined, a C expression that indicates when it is the called function's
3429responsibility to make a copy of arguments passed by invisible reference.
3430Normally, the caller makes a copy and passes the address of the copy to the
3431routine being called.  When @code{FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES} is defined and is
3432nonzero, the caller does not make a copy.  Instead, it passes a pointer to the
3433``live'' value.  The called function must not modify this value.  If it can be
3434determined that the value won't be modified, it need not make a copy;
3435otherwise a copy must be made.
3436
3437@findex FUNCTION_ARG_REG_LITTLE_ENDIAN
3438@item FUNCTION_ARG_REG_LITTLE_ENDIAN
3439If defined TRUE on a big-endian system then structure arguments passed
3440(and returned) in registers are passed in a little-endian manner instead of
3441the big-endian manner.  On the HP-UX IA64 and PA64 platforms structures are
3442aligned differently then integral values and setting this value to true will
3443allow for the special handling of structure arguments and return values.
3444
3445@findex CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3446@item CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3447A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
3448@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values.  For some target machines,
3449the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
3450argument so far.
3451
3452There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
3453arguments that have been passed on the stack.  The compiler has other
3454variables to keep track of that.  For target machines on which all
3455arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
3456@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
3457should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
3458
3459@findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3460@item INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{indirect})
3461A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable @var{cum}
3462for the state at the beginning of the argument list.  The variable has
3463type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.  The value of @var{fntype} is the tree node
3464for the data type of the function which will receive the args, or 0
3465if the args are to a compiler support library function.  The value of
3466@var{indirect} is nonzero when processing an indirect call, for example
3467a call through a function pointer.  The value of @var{indirect} is zero
3468for a call to an explicitly named function, a library function call, or when
3469@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
3470being compiled.
3471
3472When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
3473@var{libname} identifies which one.  It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
3474contains the name of the function, as a string.  @var{libname} is 0 when
3475an ordinary C function call is being processed.  Thus, each time this
3476macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
3477never both of them at once.
3478
3479@findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS
3480@item INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
3481Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
3482it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
3483@code{NULL}.  @var{indirect} would always be zero, too.  If this macro
3484is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
34850)} is used instead.
3486
3487@findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS
3488@item INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
3489Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
3490finding the arguments for the function being compiled.  If this macro is
3491undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
3492
3493The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
3494with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@.  The
3495argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
3496@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
3497@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
3498@c --mew 5feb93   i switched the order of the sentences.  --mew 10feb93
3499
3500@findex FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
3501@item FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3502A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
3503@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list.  The
3504values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
3505Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
3506the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
3507
3508This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
3509on the stack.  The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
3510used for arguments without any special help.
3511
3512@findex FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING
3513@item FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3514If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
3515to pad out an argument with extra space.  The value should be of type
3516@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
3517@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
3518
3519The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
3520multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
3521it.
3522
3523This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
3524For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward.  For
3525big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
3526constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
3527
3528@findex PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3529@item PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3530If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
3531implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
3532next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
3533controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.  If this macro is not defined, all such
3534arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
3535
3536@findex FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
3537@item FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3538If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
3539of an argument with the specified mode and type.  If it is not defined,
3540@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
3541
3542@findex FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P
3543@item FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3544A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3545register in which function arguments are sometimes passed.  This does
3546@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
3547the structure-value address.  On many machines, no registers can be
3548used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
3549stack.
3550
3551@findex LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3552@item LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3553If defined, the order in which arguments are loaded into their
3554respective argument registers is reversed so that the last
3555argument is loaded first.  This macro only affects arguments
3556passed in registers.
3557
3558@end table
3559
3560@node Scalar Return
3561@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
3562@cindex return values in registers
3563@cindex values, returned by functions
3564@cindex scalars, returned as values
3565
3566This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
3567values---values that can fit in registers.
3568
3569@table @code
3570@findex TRADITIONAL_RETURN_FLOAT
3571@item TRADITIONAL_RETURN_FLOAT
3572Define this macro if @option{-traditional} should not cause functions
3573declared to return @code{float} to convert the value to @code{double}.
3574
3575@findex FUNCTION_VALUE
3576@item FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3577A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a
3578function returns a value of data type @var{valtype}.  @var{valtype} is
3579a tree node representing a data type.  Write @code{TYPE_MODE
3580(@var{valtype})} to get the machine mode used to represent that type.
3581On many machines, only the mode is relevant.  (Actually, on most
3582machines, scalar values are returned in the same place regardless of
3583mode).
3584
3585The value of the expression is usually a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3586register where the return value is stored.  The value can also be a
3587@code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in multiple places.  See
3588@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the @code{parallel} form.
3589
3590If @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} is defined, you must apply the same
3591promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if @var{valtype} is a
3592scalar type.
3593
3594If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
3595node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3596pointer.  This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3597convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3598known.
3599
3600@code{FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return vales with aggregate data
3601types, because these are returned in another way.  See
3602@code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3603
3604@findex FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE
3605@item FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3606Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows''
3607so that the register in which a function returns its value is not
3608the same as the one in which the caller sees the value.
3609
3610For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} computes the register in which
3611the caller will see the value.  @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} should be
3612defined in a similar fashion to tell the function where to put the
3613value.
3614
3615If @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not defined,
3616@code{FUNCTION_VALUE} serves both purposes.
3617
3618@code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not used for return vales with
3619aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way.  See
3620@code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3621
3622@findex LIBCALL_VALUE
3623@item LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
3624A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
3625function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.  If the precise function
3626being called is known, @var{func} is a tree node
3627(@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3628pointer.  This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3629convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3630known.
3631
3632Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
3633support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
3634specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
3635compiled.
3636
3637The definition of @code{LIBRARY_VALUE} need not be concerned aggregate
3638data types, because none of the library functions returns such types.
3639
3640@findex FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
3641@item FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3642A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3643register in which the values of called function may come back.
3644
3645A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
3646second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
3647recognized by this macro.  So for most machines, this definition
3648suffices:
3649
3650@example
3651#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3652@end example
3653
3654If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
3655function use different registers for the return value, this macro
3656should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
3657
3658@findex APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3659@item APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3660Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
3661need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
3662saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
3663@end table
3664
3665@node Aggregate Return
3666@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
3667@cindex aggregates as return values
3668@cindex large return values
3669@cindex returning aggregate values
3670@cindex structure value address
3671
3672When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
3673cases), the value is not returned according to @code{FUNCTION_VALUE}
3674(@pxref{Scalar Return}).  Instead, the caller passes the address of a
3675block of memory in which the value should be stored.  This address
3676is called the @dfn{structure value address}.
3677
3678This section describes how to control returning structure values in
3679memory.
3680
3681@table @code
3682@findex RETURN_IN_MEMORY
3683@item RETURN_IN_MEMORY (@var{type})
3684A C expression which can inhibit the returning of certain function
3685values in registers, based on the type of value.  A nonzero value says
3686to return the function value in memory, just as large structures are
3687always returned.  Here @var{type} will be a C expression of type
3688@code{tree}, representing the data type of the value.
3689
3690Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
3691by this macro.  Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
3692takes effect regardless of this macro.  On most systems, it is
3693possible to leave the macro undefined; this causes a default
3694definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
3695values, and 0 otherwise.
3696
3697Do not use this macro to indicate that structures and unions should always
3698be returned in memory.  You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
3699to indicate this.
3700
3701@findex DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3702@item DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3703Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
3704in memory.  Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
3705only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
3706If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
3707and union return values are decided by the @code{RETURN_IN_MEMORY} macro.
3708
3709If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
3710
3711@findex STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3712@item STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3713If the structure value address is passed in a register, then
3714@code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} should be the number of that register.
3715
3716@findex STRUCT_VALUE
3717@item STRUCT_VALUE
3718If the structure value address is not passed in a register, define
3719@code{STRUCT_VALUE} as an expression returning an RTX for the place
3720where the address is passed.  If it returns 0, the address is passed as
3721an ``invisible'' first argument.
3722
3723@findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3724@item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3725On some architectures the place where the structure value address
3726is found by the called function is not the same place that the
3727caller put it.  This can be due to register windows, or it could
3728be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
3729
3730If the incoming location of the structure value address is in a
3731register, define this macro as the register number.
3732
3733@findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3734@item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3735If the incoming location is not a register, then you should define
3736@code{STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING} as an expression for an RTX for where the
3737called function should find the value.  If it should find the value on
3738the stack, define this to create a @code{mem} which refers to the frame
3739pointer.  A definition of 0 means that the address is passed as an
3740``invisible'' first argument.
3741
3742@findex PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3743@item PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3744Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
3745for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
3746the address of a static variable containing the value.
3747
3748Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
3749pass an address to the subroutine.
3750
3751This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
3752nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
3753@end table
3754
3755@node Caller Saves
3756@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
3757
3758If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls.  This
3759makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
3760must live across calls.
3761
3762@table @code
3763@findex DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3764@item DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3765Define this macro if function calls on the target machine do not preserve
3766any registers; in other words, if @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} has 1
3767for all registers.  When defined, this macro enables @option{-fcaller-saves}
3768by default for all optimization levels.  It has no effect for optimization
3769levels 2 and higher, where @option{-fcaller-saves} is the default.
3770
3771@findex CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE
3772@item CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
3773A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
3774a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
3775restoring it around each function call.  The expression should be 1 when
3776this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
3777
3778If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
3779machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
3780
3781@findex HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE
3782@item HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
3783A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
3784of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}.  If
3785@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
3786returned.  For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
3787will select the smallest suitable mode.
3788@end table
3789
3790@node Function Entry
3791@subsection Function Entry and Exit
3792@cindex function entry and exit
3793@cindex prologue
3794@cindex epilogue
3795
3796This section describes the macros that output function entry
3797(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
3798
3799@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
3800If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
3801function.  The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
3802initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
3803saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
3804local variables.  @var{size} is an integer.  @var{file} is a stdio
3805stream to which the assembler code should be output.
3806
3807The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
3808macro.  That has already been done when the macro is run.
3809
3810@findex regs_ever_live
3811To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
3812@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
3813@var{r} is used anywhere within the function.  This implies the function
3814prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
3815call-used registers.  (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
3816@code{regs_ever_live}.)
3817
3818On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
3819not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
3820they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
3821appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
3822registers are used in the function.
3823
3824@findex frame_pointer_needed
3825On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
3826function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
3827pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise.  To determine whether a
3828frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
3829@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 at run
3830time in a function that needs a frame pointer.  @xref{Elimination}.
3831
3832The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
3833required for the function.  This stack space consists of the regions
3834listed below.  In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
3835order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
3836stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
3837the highest address if it is not defined).  You can use a different order
3838for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
3839compatibility reasons.  Except in cases where required by standard
3840or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
3841need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
3842@end deftypefn
3843
3844@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
3845If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
3846prologue.  This should be used when the function prologue is being
3847emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
3848emitted.  @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
3849@end deftypefn
3850
3851@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
3852If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
3853epilogue.  This should be used when the function epilogue is being
3854emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
3855emitted.  @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
3856@end deftypefn
3857
3858@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
3859If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
3860function.  The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
3861registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
3862called, and returning control to the caller.  This macro takes the
3863same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
3864registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
3865@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
3866
3867On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
3868of returning from the function.  On these machines, give that
3869instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
3870@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
3871
3872Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
3873@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used.  If you want the target
3874switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
3875define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
3876target switches appropriately.  If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
3877condition is false, epilogues will be used.
3878
3879On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
3880function exit code must vary accordingly.  Sometimes the code for these
3881two cases is completely different.  To determine whether a frame pointer
3882is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
3883@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
3884a function that needs a frame pointer.
3885
3886Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
3887@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
3888The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
3889function.  @xref{Leaf Functions}.
3890
3891On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
3892others leave that for the caller to do.  For example, the 68020 when
3893given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
3894number of arguments.
3895
3896@findex current_function_pops_args
3897Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
3898functions pop their own arguments.  @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
3899needs to know what was decided.  The variable that is called
3900@code{current_function_pops_args} is the number of bytes of its
3901arguments that a function should pop.  @xref{Scalar Return}.
3902@c what is the "its arguments" in the above sentence referring to, pray
3903@c tell?  --mew 5feb93
3904@end deftypefn
3905
3906@table @code
3907
3908@itemize @bullet
3909@item
3910@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
3911A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
3912uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
3913stack.  (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
3914if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
3915arguments.  But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
3916yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.)  This
3917region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
3918registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
3919features in @code{<varargs.h>} and @code{<stdarg.h>}.
3920
3921@item
3922An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
3923The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
3924the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
3925machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
3926in the function.  Machines with register windows often do not require
3927a save area.
3928
3929@item
3930A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
3931boundary, to contain the local variables of the function.  On some machines,
3932this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
3933save area closer to the top of the stack.
3934
3935@item
3936@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
3937Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
3938@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
3939argument lists of the function.  @xref{Stack Arguments}.
3940@end itemize
3941
3942Normally, it is necessary for the macros
3943@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
3944@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to treat leaf functions specially.
3945The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
3946function.
3947
3948@findex EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
3949@item EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
3950Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
3951instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
3952pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
3953adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function.
3954
3955Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
3956frame pointers are maintained.  It is never safe to delete a final
3957stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
3958compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
3959
3960@findex EPILOGUE_USES
3961@item EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
3962Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
3963used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern.  The stack and frame
3964pointer registers are already be assumed to be used as needed.
3965
3966@findex EH_USES
3967@item EH_USES (@var{regno})
3968Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
3969used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
3970on entry to an exception edge.
3971
3972@findex DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
3973@item DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
3974Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
3975instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''.  The
3976definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
3977representing the number of delay slots there.
3978
3979@findex ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY
3980@item ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
3981A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
3982slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
3983
3984The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
3985being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
3986eligibility).  It is never negative and is always less than the number
3987of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
3988If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
3989may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot.  Also, other insns may
3990(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
3991slot.
3992
3993@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
3994@findex final_scan_insn
3995The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
3996list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
3997@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}.  The insn for the first
3998delay slot comes first in the list.  Your definition of the macro
3999@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4000outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4001@code{final_scan_insn}.
4002
4003You need not define this macro if you did not define
4004@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4005
4006@findex ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4007@item ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (@var{file}, @var{thunk_fndecl}, @var{delta}, @var{function})
4008A C compound statement that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4009function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4010inheritance.  The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4011adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4012the real function.
4013
4014First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4015contains the incoming first argument.  Assume that this argument
4016contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4017in C++.  This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4018e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc.  The addition must preserve the values of
4019all other incoming arguments.
4020
4021After the addition, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4022@code{FUNCTION_DECL}.  This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4023not touch the return address.  Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4024return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4025
4026The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4027the adjusted first argument.  This macro is responsible for emitting all
4028of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4029and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4030
4031The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant.  (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4032have already been extracted from it.)  It might possibly be useful on
4033some targets, but probably not.
4034
4035If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4036front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4037@var{function} instead of jumping to it.  The generic approach does
4038not support varargs.
4039@end table
4040
4041@node Profiling
4042@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4043@cindex profiling, code generation
4044
4045These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4046
4047@table @code
4048@findex FUNCTION_PROFILER
4049@item FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4050A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4051assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4052
4053@findex mcount
4054The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4055your operating system environment, not by GCC@.  To figure them out,
4056compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4057compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4058
4059Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4060variable to be loaded into some register.  The name of this variable is
4061@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4062the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4063
4064@findex PROFILE_HOOK
4065@item PROFILE_HOOK
4066A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4067code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4068not support profiling.
4069
4070@findex NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4071@item NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4072Define this macro if the @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does
4073not need a counter variable allocated for each function.  This is true
4074for almost all modern implementations.  If you define this macro, you
4075must not use the @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4076
4077@findex PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4078@item PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4079Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4080the function prologue.  Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4081
4082
4083@findex TARGET_ALLOWS_PROFILING_WITHOUT_FRAME_POINTER
4084@item TARGET_ALLOWS_PROFILING_WITHOUT_FRAME_POINTER
4085On some targets, it is impossible to use profiling when the frame
4086pointer has been omitted.  For example, on x86 GNU/Linux systems,
4087the @code{mcount} routine provided by the GNU C Library finds the
4088address of the routine that called the routine that called @code{mcount}
4089by looking in the immediate caller's stack frame.  If the immediate
4090caller has no frame pointer, this lookup will fail.
4091
4092By default, GCC assumes that the target does allow profiling when the
4093frame pointer is omitted.  This macro should be defined to a C
4094expression that evaluates to @code{false} if the target does not allow
4095profiling when the frame pointer is omitted.
4096
4097@end table
4098
4099@node Tail Calls
4100@subsection Permitting tail calls
4101@cindex tail calls
4102
4103@table @code
4104@findex FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4105@item FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (@var{decl})
4106A C expression that evaluates to true if it is ok to perform a sibling
4107call to @var{decl} from the current function.
4108
4109It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4110tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4111during PIC compilation.  Use this macro to enforce these restrictions,
4112as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4113``normal'' call.
4114@end table
4115
4116@node Varargs
4117@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4118@cindex varargs implementation
4119
4120GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4121@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4122on the stack.  Other machines require their own implementations of
4123varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4124conditionals to include it.
4125
4126ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4127the calling convention for @code{va_start}.  The traditional
4128implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4129to store the argument pointer.  The ISO implementation of
4130@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument.  The user is
4131supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4132
4133However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument.  The way to find
4134the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4135below.
4136
4137@table @code
4138@findex __builtin_saveregs
4139@item __builtin_saveregs ()
4140Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4141that the varargs mechanism can access them.  Both ISO and traditional
4142versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4143you use @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4144
4145On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4146control of the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  On other machines,
4147it calls a routine written in assembler language, found in
4148@file{libgcc2.c}.
4149
4150Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4151beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4152@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4153This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4154to use them for its own purposes.
4155@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4156@c 10feb93
4157
4158@findex __builtin_args_info
4159@item __builtin_args_info (@var{category})
4160Use this built-in function to find the first anonymous arguments in
4161registers.
4162
4163In general, a machine may have several categories of registers used for
4164arguments, each for a particular category of data types.  (For example,
4165on some machines, floating-point registers are used for floating-point
4166arguments while other arguments are passed in the general registers.)
4167To make non-varargs functions use the proper calling convention, you
4168have defined the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data type to record how many
4169registers in each category have been used so far
4170
4171@code{__builtin_args_info} accesses the same data structure of type
4172@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} after the ordinary argument layout is finished
4173with it, with @var{category} specifying which word to access.  Thus, the
4174value indicates the first unused register in a given category.
4175
4176Normally, you would use @code{__builtin_args_info} in the implementation
4177of @code{va_start}, accessing each category just once and storing the
4178value in the @code{va_list} object.  This is because @code{va_list} will
4179have to update the values, and there is no way to alter the
4180values accessed by @code{__builtin_args_info}.
4181
4182@findex __builtin_next_arg
4183@item __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4184This is the equivalent of @code{__builtin_args_info}, for stack
4185arguments.  It returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4186argument, as type @code{void *}.  If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4187returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4188argument.  Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4189fetching arguments from the stack.  Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4190verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4191of the current function.
4192
4193@findex __builtin_classify_type
4194@item __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4195Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4196passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4197has to embody these conventions.  The easiest way to categorize the
4198specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4199with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4200
4201@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4202considering only its data type.  It returns an integer describing what
4203kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4204
4205The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4206interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4207@end table
4208
4209These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4210
4211@table @code
4212@findex EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4213@item EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS ()
4214If defined, is a C expression that produces the machine-specific code
4215for a call to @code{__builtin_saveregs}.  This code will be moved to the
4216very beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made.
4217The return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the
4218value to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4219
4220@findex SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4221@item SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (@var{args_so_far}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{pretend_args_size}, @var{second_time})
4222This macro offers an alternative to using @code{__builtin_saveregs} and
4223defining the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  Use it to store the
4224anonymous register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments
4225appear to have been passed consecutively on the stack.  Once this is
4226done, you can use the standard implementation of varargs that works for
4227machines that pass all their arguments on the stack.
4228
4229The argument @var{args_so_far} is the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4230structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4231named arguments.  The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4232last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4233
4234The macro implementation should do two things: first, push onto the
4235stack all the argument registers @emph{not} used for the named
4236arguments, and second, store the size of the data thus pushed into the
4237@code{int}-valued variable whose name is supplied as the argument
4238@var{pretend_args_size}.  The value that you store here will serve as
4239additional offset for setting up the stack frame.
4240
4241Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4242compile time without knowing their data types,
4243@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that have just
4244a single category of argument register and use it uniformly for all data
4245types.
4246
4247If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4248arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time.  This
4249happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
4250end of the source file.  The macro @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
4251not generate any instructions in this case.
4252
4253@findex STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4254@item STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4255Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the location where a function
4256argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
4257
4258This macro controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4259is set for varargs and stdarg functions.  If this macro returns a
4260nonzero value, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
4261arguments, and false for unnamed arguments.  If it returns a value of
4262zero, but @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is defined, then all arguments
4263are treated as named.  Otherwise, all named arguments except the last
4264are treated as named.
4265
4266You need not define this macro if it always returns zero.
4267
4268@findex PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4269@item PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4270If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
4271@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
4272@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
4273defined, then define this macro to return nonzero if
4274@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, zero otherwise.
4275Otherwise, you should not define this macro.
4276@end table
4277
4278@node Trampolines
4279@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
4280@cindex trampolines for nested functions
4281@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
4282
4283A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
4284when the address of a nested function is taken.  It normally resides on
4285the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function.  These macros
4286tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
4287trampoline.
4288
4289The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
4290address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
4291the nested function.  On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
4292two instructions, a move immediate and a jump.  Then the two addresses
4293exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands.  On RISC
4294machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
4295two parts.  Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
4296operands.
4297
4298The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
4299parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
4300immediate operands of the instructions.  On a CISC machine, this is
4301simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
4302proper offset from the start of the trampoline.  On a RISC machine, it
4303may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
4304separately.
4305
4306@table @code
4307@findex TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
4308@item TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (@var{file})
4309A C statement to output, on the stream @var{file}, assembler code for a
4310block of data that contains the constant parts of a trampoline.  This
4311code should not include a label---the label is taken care of
4312automatically.
4313
4314If you do not define this macro, it means no template is needed
4315for the target.  Do not define this macro on systems where the block move
4316code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
4317to generate it on the spot.
4318
4319@findex TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4320@item TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4321The name of a subroutine to switch to the section in which the
4322trampoline template is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}).  The default is
4323a value of @samp{readonly_data_section}, which places the trampoline in
4324the section containing read-only data.
4325
4326@findex TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4327@item TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4328A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
4329
4330@findex TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4331@item TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4332Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
4333
4334If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
4335is used for aligning trampolines.
4336
4337@findex INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE
4338@item INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{addr}, @var{fnaddr}, @var{static_chain})
4339A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline.
4340@var{addr} is an RTX for the address of the trampoline; @var{fnaddr} is
4341an RTX for the address of the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
4342RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
4343when it is called.
4344
4345@findex TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
4346@item TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (@var{addr})
4347A C statement that should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
4348the address of the trampoline.  Its argument contains the address that
4349was passed to @code{INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE}.  In case the address to be
4350used for a function call should be different from the address in which
4351the template was stored, the different address should be assigned to
4352@var{addr}.  If this macro is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for
4353function calls.
4354
4355@findex ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE
4356@item ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{fp})
4357A C expression to allocate run-time space for a trampoline.  The
4358expression value should be an RTX representing a memory reference to the
4359space for the trampoline.
4360
4361@cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} and trampolines
4362@cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and trampolines
4363If this macro is not defined, by default the trampoline is allocated as
4364a stack slot.  This default is right for most machines.  The exceptions
4365are machines where it is impossible to execute instructions in the stack
4366area.  On such machines, you may have to implement a separate stack,
4367using this macro in conjunction with @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4368and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}.
4369
4370@var{fp} points to a data structure, a @code{struct function}, which
4371describes the compilation status of the immediate containing function of
4372the function which the trampoline is for.  Normally (when
4373@code{ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE} is not defined), the stack slot for the
4374trampoline is in the stack frame of this containing function.  Other
4375allocation strategies probably must do something analogous with this
4376information.
4377@end table
4378
4379Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
4380separate instruction and data caches.  Writing into a stack location
4381fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
4382jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
4383
4384Here are two possible solutions.  One is to clear the relevant parts of
4385the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up.  The other is to
4386make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
4387subroutine.  The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
4388latter makes initialization faster.
4389
4390To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
4391the following macros which describe the shape of the cache.
4392
4393@table @code
4394@findex INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4395@item INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4396The total size in bytes of the cache.
4397
4398@findex INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4399@item INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4400The length in bytes of each cache line.  The cache is divided into cache
4401lines which are disjoint slots, each holding a contiguous chunk of data
4402fetched from memory.  Each time data is brought into the cache, an
4403entire line is read at once.  The data loaded into a cache line is
4404always aligned on a boundary equal to the line size.
4405
4406@findex INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4407@item INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4408The number of alternative cache lines that can hold any particular memory
4409location.
4410@end table
4411
4412Alternatively, if the machine has system calls or instructions to clear
4413the instruction cache directly, you can define the following macro.
4414
4415@table @code
4416@findex CLEAR_INSN_CACHE
4417@item CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
4418If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
4419cache} in the specified interval.  If it is not defined, and the macro
4420@code{INSN_CACHE_SIZE} is defined, some generic code is generated to clear the
4421cache.  The definition of this macro would typically be a series of
4422@code{asm} statements.  Both @var{beg} and @var{end} are both pointer
4423expressions.
4424@end table
4425
4426To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro.  In addition,
4427you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
4428cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
4429beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
4430its cache line.  Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
4431
4432@table @code
4433@findex TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4434@item TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4435Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
4436work.  The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
4437which will be compiled with GCC@.  They go in a library function named
4438@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
4439
4440If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
4441C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
4442special label of your own in the assembler code.  Use one @code{asm}
4443statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
4444global.  Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
4445special assembler code.
4446@end table
4447
4448@node Library Calls
4449@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
4450@cindex library subroutine names
4451@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
4452
4453@c prevent bad page break with this line
4454Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
4455
4456@table @code
4457@findex MULSI3_LIBCALL
4458@item MULSI3_LIBCALL
4459A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4460multiplication of one signed full-word by another.  If you do not
4461define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__mulsi3},
4462a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4463
4464@findex DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4465@item DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4466A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4467division of one signed full-word by another.  If you do not define
4468this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divsi3}, a
4469function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4470
4471@findex UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4472@item UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4473A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4474division of one unsigned full-word by another.  If you do not define
4475this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivsi3}, a
4476function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4477
4478@findex MODSI3_LIBCALL
4479@item MODSI3_LIBCALL
4480A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4481remainder in division of one signed full-word by another.  If you do
4482not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4483@code{__modsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4484
4485@findex UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4486@item UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4487A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4488remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another.  If you do
4489not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4490@code{__umodsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4491
4492@findex MULDI3_LIBCALL
4493@item MULDI3_LIBCALL
4494A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4495multiplication of one signed double-word by another.  If you do not
4496define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__muldi3},
4497a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4498
4499@findex DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4500@item DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4501A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4502division of one signed double-word by another.  If you do not define
4503this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divdi3}, a
4504function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4505
4506@findex UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4507@item UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4508A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4509division of one unsigned full-word by another.  If you do not define
4510this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivdi3}, a
4511function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4512
4513@findex MODDI3_LIBCALL
4514@item MODDI3_LIBCALL
4515A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4516remainder in division of one signed double-word by another.  If you do
4517not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4518@code{__moddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4519
4520@findex UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4521@item UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4522A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4523remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another.  If you do
4524not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4525@code{__umoddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4526
4527@findex INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4528@item INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4529Define this macro as a C statement that declares additional library
4530routines renames existing ones.  @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after
4531initializing all the normal library routines.
4532
4533@findex FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
4534@item FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL
4535Define this macro as a C statement that returns nonzero if a call to
4536the floating point comparison library function will return a boolean
4537value that indicates the result of the comparison.  It should return
4538zero if one of gcc's own libgcc functions is called.
4539
4540Most ports don't need to define this macro.
4541
4542@findex TARGET_EDOM
4543@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
4544@item TARGET_EDOM
4545The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
4546expression.  If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
4547deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly.  Look in
4548@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
4549system.
4550
4551If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
4552domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
4553error.  If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
4554there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
4555that @code{matherr} is used normally.
4556
4557@findex GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4558@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
4559@item GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4560Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
4561refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}.  (On certain systems,
4562@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.)  If you don't define this
4563macro, a reasonable default is used.
4564
4565@findex TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4566@cindex @code{bcopy}, implicit usage
4567@cindex @code{memcpy}, implicit usage
4568@cindex @code{memmove}, implicit usage
4569@cindex @code{bzero}, implicit usage
4570@cindex @code{memset}, implicit usage
4571@item TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4572Define this macro if GCC should generate calls to the ISO C
4573(and System V) library functions @code{memcpy}, @code{memmove} and
4574@code{memset} rather than the BSD functions @code{bcopy} and @code{bzero}.
4575
4576@findex LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4577@item LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4578Define this macro if @code{float} arguments cannot be passed to library
4579routines (so they must be converted to @code{double}).  This macro
4580affects both how library calls are generated and how the library
4581routines in @file{libgcc.a} accept their arguments.  It is useful on
4582machines where floating and fixed point arguments are passed
4583differently, such as the i860.
4584
4585@findex NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4586@item NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4587Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
4588the calling convention of the NeXT system.  This calling convention
4589involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
4590at once to the method-lookup library function.
4591
4592The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
4593to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
4594@end table
4595
4596@node Addressing Modes
4597@section Addressing Modes
4598@cindex addressing modes
4599
4600@c prevent bad page break with this line
4601This is about addressing modes.
4602
4603@table @code
4604@findex HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4605@findex HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4606@findex HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4607@findex HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4608@item HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4609@itemx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4610@itemx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4611@itemx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4612A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
4613pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
4614
4615@findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4616@findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4617@item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4618@itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4619A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4620post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
4621the size of the memory operand.
4622
4623@findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4624@findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4625@item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4626@itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4627A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4628post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
4629
4630@findex CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P
4631@item CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
4632A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
4633is a valid address.  On most machines, this can be defined as
4634@code{CONSTANT_P (@var{x})}, but a few machines are more restrictive
4635in which constant addresses are supported.
4636
4637@findex CONSTANT_P
4638@code{CONSTANT_P} accepts integer-values expressions whose values are
4639not explicitly known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and
4640@code{high} expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in
4641addition to @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
4642
4643@findex MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4644@item MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4645A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
4646memory address.  Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
4647the maximum number that @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} would ever
4648accept.
4649
4650@findex GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS
4651@item GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
4652A C compound statement with a conditional @code{goto @var{label};}
4653executed if @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the
4654target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
4655
4656It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as
4657subroutines for this one.  Otherwise it may be too complicated to
4658understand.
4659
4660This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a
4661non-strict one.  The strict variant is used in the reload pass.  It
4662must be defined so that any pseudo-register that has not been
4663allocated a hard register is considered a memory reference.  In
4664contexts where some kind of register is required, a pseudo-register
4665with no hard register must be rejected.
4666
4667The non-strict variant is used in other passes.  It must be defined to
4668accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
4669register is required.
4670
4671@findex REG_OK_STRICT
4672Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
4673macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}.  You should use an
4674@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant
4675in that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
4676
4677Subroutines to check for acceptable registers for various purposes (one
4678for base registers, one for index registers, and so on) are typically
4679among the subroutines used to define @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}.
4680Then only these subroutine macros need have two variants; the higher
4681levels of macros may be the same whether strict or not.
4682
4683Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
4684and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
4685constant.  Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
4686specifically as legitimate addresses.  Normally you would simply
4687recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
4688
4689Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
4690sums that are not marked with  @code{const}.  It assumes that a naked
4691@code{plus} indicates indexing.  If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
4692naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
4693be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4694
4695@cindex @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
4696On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
4697the section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the
4698macro @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
4699@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  When you see a
4700@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
4701@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section.  @xref{Assembler
4702Format}.
4703
4704@findex saveable_obstack
4705The best way to modify the name string is by adding text to the
4706beginning, with suitable punctuation to prevent any ambiguity.  Allocate
4707the new name in @code{saveable_obstack}.  You will have to modify
4708@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to remove and decode the added text and
4709output the name accordingly, and define @code{STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} to
4710access the original name string.
4711
4712You can check the information stored here into the @code{symbol_ref} in
4713the definitions of the macros @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and
4714@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4715
4716@findex REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4717@item REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x})
4718A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4719RTX) is valid for use as a base register.  For hard registers, it
4720should always accept those which the hardware permits and reject the
4721others.  Whether the macro accepts or rejects pseudo registers must be
4722controlled by @code{REG_OK_STRICT} as described above.  This usually
4723requires two variant definitions, of which @code{REG_OK_STRICT}
4724controls the one actually used.
4725
4726@findex REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4727@item REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x}, @var{mode})
4728A C expression that is just like @code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
4729that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
4730@var{mode}.  You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
4731reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register.  If
4732you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
4733@code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
4734
4735@findex REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
4736@item REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{x})
4737A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4738RTX) is valid for use as an index register.
4739
4740The difference between an index register and a base register is that
4741the index register may be scaled.  If an address involves the sum of
4742two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
4743labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
4744labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
4745may serve in each capacity.  The compiler will try both labelings,
4746looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
4747only if neither labeling works.
4748
4749@findex FIND_BASE_TERM
4750@item FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
4751A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x}.
4752This macro is used in only one place: `find_base_term' in alias.c.
4753
4754It is always safe for this macro to not be defined.  It exists so
4755that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
4756
4757The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
4758a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
4759
4760@findex LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
4761@item LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{oldx}, @var{mode}, @var{win})
4762A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x} with a valid
4763memory address for an operand of mode @var{mode}.  @var{win} will be a
4764C statement label elsewhere in the code; the macro definition may use
4765
4766@example
4767GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{win});
4768@end example
4769
4770@noindent
4771to avoid further processing if the address has become legitimate.
4772
4773@findex break_out_memory_refs
4774@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
4775and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
4776@var{x}.
4777
4778The code generated by this macro should not alter the substructure of
4779@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
4780should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
4781
4782It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
4783address.  The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases.  In
4784fact, it is safe for this macro to do nothing.  But often a
4785machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
4786
4787@findex LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS
4788@item LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
4789A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
4790that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
4791@var{mode}.  @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
4792It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
4793performance reasons.
4794
4795For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
4796reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
4797registers into a register.  On the other hand, for number of RISC
4798processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
4799needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot.  By defining
4800@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
4801generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
4802be shared.
4803
4804@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution.  It is necessary
4805to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
4806and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
4807of reload internals.
4808
4809@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
4810previous invocation of this macro.  If it fails to handle such addresses
4811then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
4812
4813@findex push_reload
4814The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
4815need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
4816suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
4817
4818The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
4819@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
4820should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
4821This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
4822@code{push_reload}.
4823
4824@findex strict_memory_address_p
4825The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
4826the address has become legitimate.
4827
4828@findex copy_rtx
4829If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
4830this is to use @code{copy_rtx}.  Note, however, that is unshares only a
4831single level of rtl.  Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
4832top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
4833It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
4834address;  but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
4835
4836@findex GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS
4837@item GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
4838A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
4839@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
4840different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
4841reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
4842but not others.
4843
4844Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
4845effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
4846of the operand being addressed.  Some machines have other mode-dependent
4847addresses.  Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
4848
4849You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
4850
4851@findex LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
4852@item LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
4853A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
4854an immediate operand on the target machine.  You can assume that
4855@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.  In fact,
4856@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
4857anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
4858@end table
4859
4860@node Condition Code
4861@section Condition Code Status
4862@cindex condition code status
4863
4864@c prevent bad page break with this line
4865This describes the condition code status.
4866
4867@findex cc_status
4868The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
4869describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
4870the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by).  This
4871variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
4872currently based, and several standard flags.
4873
4874Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
4875description header file.  It can also add additional machine-specific
4876information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
4877
4878@table @code
4879@findex CC_STATUS_MDEP
4880@item CC_STATUS_MDEP
4881C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
4882component of @code{cc_status}.  It defaults to @code{int}.
4883
4884This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4885
4886@findex CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
4887@item CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
4888A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
4889The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
4890the field anyway.  If you want to use the field, you should probably
4891define this macro to initialize it.
4892
4893This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4894
4895@findex NOTICE_UPDATE_CC
4896@item NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
4897A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
4898appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}.  It is
4899this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
4900code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
4901set @code{(cc0)}.
4902
4903This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4904
4905If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
4906other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
4907invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
4908reflecting.  For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
4909registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
4910@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
4911insns.  But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
4912based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
4913value in @samp{a4}.  Although the condition code is not changed by
4914this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
4915@samp{a4@@(102)}.  Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
4916@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
4917condition code value.
4918
4919The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
4920with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
4921@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
4922constants which are just the operands.  The RTL structure of these
4923insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do.  What
4924@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
4925@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
4926
4927A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
4928that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
4929@samp{cc}.  This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
4930two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
4931
4932@findex EXTRA_CC_MODES
4933@item EXTRA_CC_MODES
4934A list of additional modes for condition code values in registers
4935(@pxref{Jump Patterns}).  This macro should expand to a sequence of
4936calls of the macro @code{CC} separated by white space.  @code{CC} takes
4937two arguments.  The first is the enumeration name of the mode, which
4938should begin with @samp{CC} and end with @samp{mode}.  The second is a C
4939string giving the printable name of the mode; it should be the same as
4940the first argument, but with the trailing @samp{mode} removed.
4941
4942You should only define this macro if additional modes are required.
4943
4944A sample definition of @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is:
4945@smallexample
4946#define EXTRA_CC_MODES            \
4947    CC(CC_NOOVmode, "CC_NOOV")    \
4948    CC(CCFPmode, "CCFP")          \
4949    CC(CCFPEmode, "CCFPE")
4950@end smallexample
4951
4952@findex SELECT_CC_MODE
4953@item SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
4954Returns a mode from class @code{MODE_CC} to be used when comparison
4955operation code @var{op} is applied to rtx @var{x} and @var{y}.  For
4956example, on the Sparc, @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} is defined as (see
4957@pxref{Jump Patterns} for a description of the reason for this
4958definition)
4959
4960@smallexample
4961#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
4962  (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT          \
4963   ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode)    \
4964   : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS    \
4965       || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
4966      ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
4967@end smallexample
4968
4969You need not define this macro if @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is not defined.
4970
4971@findex CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON
4972@item CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
4973On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
4974convert an invalid comparison into a valid one.  For example, the Alpha
4975does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
4976comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
4977
4978On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
4979required conversions.  @var{code} is the initial comparison code
4980and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
4981comparison, respectively.  You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
4982@var{op1} as required.
4983
4984GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
4985valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
4986@file{md} file.
4987
4988You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
4989code or operands.
4990
4991@findex REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE
4992@item REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
4993A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
4994comparison whose mode is @var{mode}.  If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
4995can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
4996then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
4997
4998You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
4999floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5000For example, here is the definition used on the Sparc, where floating-point
5001inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5002
5003@smallexample
5004#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE)  ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5005@end smallexample
5006
5007@findex REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5008A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5009comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}.  The macro is used only in case
5010@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero.  Define this macro in case
5011machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals.  For
5012instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5013freely convert unordered compares to ordered one.  Then definition may look
5014like:
5015
5016@smallexample
5017#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5018   ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5019    : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5020@end smallexample
5021
5022@findex REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P
5023@item REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{code1}, @var{code2})
5024A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
5025@var{code1} is the inverse of @var{code2} and vice versa.  Define this to
5026return 0 if the target has conditional execution predicates that cannot be
5027reversed safely.  If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as
5028follows:
5029
5030@smallexample
5031#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
5032   ((x) == reverse_condition (y))
5033@end smallexample
5034
5035@end table
5036
5037@node Costs
5038@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
5039@cindex costs of instructions
5040@cindex relative costs
5041@cindex speed of instructions
5042
5043These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
5044on the target machine.
5045
5046@table @code
5047@findex CONST_COSTS
5048@item CONST_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5049A part of a C @code{switch} statement that describes the relative costs
5050of constant RTL expressions.  It must contain @code{case} labels for
5051expression codes @code{const_int}, @code{const}, @code{symbol_ref},
5052@code{label_ref} and @code{const_double}.  Each case must ultimately
5053reach a @code{return} statement to return the relative cost of the use
5054of that kind of constant value in an expression.  The cost may depend on
5055the precise value of the constant, which is available for examination in
5056@var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression in which it is contained,
5057found in @var{outer_code}.
5058
5059@var{code} is the expression code---redundant, since it can be
5060obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
5061
5062@findex RTX_COSTS
5063@findex COSTS_N_INSNS
5064@item RTX_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5065Like @code{CONST_COSTS} but applies to nonconstant RTL expressions.
5066This can be used, for example, to indicate how costly a multiply
5067instruction is.  In writing this macro, you can use the construct
5068@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
5069instructions.  @var{outer_code} is the code of the expression in which
5070@var{x} is contained.
5071
5072This macro is optional; do not define it if the default cost assumptions
5073are adequate for the target machine.
5074
5075@findex DEFAULT_RTX_COSTS
5076@item DEFAULT_RTX_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5077This macro, if defined, is called for any case not handled by the
5078@code{RTX_COSTS} or @code{CONST_COSTS} macros.  This eliminates the need
5079to put case labels into the macro, but the code, or any functions it
5080calls, must assume that the RTL in @var{x} could be of any type that has
5081not already been handled.  The arguments are the same as for
5082@code{RTX_COSTS}, and the macro should execute a return statement giving
5083the cost of any RTL expressions that it can handle.  The default cost
5084calculation is used for any RTL for which this macro does not return a
5085value.
5086
5087This macro is optional; do not define it if the default cost assumptions
5088are adequate for the target machine.
5089
5090@findex ADDRESS_COST
5091@item ADDRESS_COST (@var{address})
5092An expression giving the cost of an addressing mode that contains
5093@var{address}.  If not defined, the cost is computed from
5094the @var{address} expression and the @code{CONST_COSTS} values.
5095
5096For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
5097true cost of the addressing mode.  However, on RISC machines, all
5098instructions normally have the same length and execution time.  Hence
5099all addresses will have equal costs.
5100
5101In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
5102the lowest cost will be used.  If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
5103cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
5104
5105For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
5106and a constant is used twice in the same basic block.  When this macro
5107is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
5108references will be indirect through that register.  On machines where
5109the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
5110that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
5111instruction and possibly require an additional register.  Proper
5112specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
5113
5114Similar use of this macro is made in strength reduction of loops.
5115
5116@var{address} need not be valid as an address.  In such a case, the cost
5117is not relevant and can be any value; invalid addresses need not be
5118assigned a different cost.
5119
5120On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
5121cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
5122@code{ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to be live
5123over a region of code where only one would have been if
5124@code{ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner.  This effect should
5125be considered in the definition of this macro.  Equivalent costs should
5126probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of registers
5127on machines with lots of registers.
5128
5129This macro will normally either not be defined or be defined as a
5130constant.
5131
5132@findex REGISTER_MOVE_COST
5133@item REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
5134A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
5135register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}.  The classes are
5136expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  A
5137value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
5138that.
5139
5140It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
5141same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
5142registers if they are not general registers.
5143
5144If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
5145hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
5146classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
5147constraints of the insn are met.  Setting a cost of other than 2 will
5148allow reload to verify that the constraints are met.  You should do this
5149if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
5150
5151@findex MEMORY_MOVE_COST
5152@item MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
5153A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
5154register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
5155is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in.  This cost
5156is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.  If moving between
5157registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
5158should define this macro to express the relative cost.
5159
5160If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
5161the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
5162needed.  If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
5163between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
5164more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
5165reflect the actual cost of the move.
5166
5167GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
5168secondary reloads are needed.  It computes the costs due to copying via
5169a secondary register.  If your machine copies from memory using a
5170secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
51714 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
5172value to the result of that function.  The arguments to that function
5173are the same as to this macro.
5174
5175@findex BRANCH_COST
5176@item BRANCH_COST
5177A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction.  A value of 1 is
5178the default; other values are interpreted relative to that.
5179@end table
5180
5181Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
5182but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
5183ordinarily expect.
5184
5185@table @code
5186@findex SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5187@item SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5188Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
5189than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
5190faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
5191require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
5192between byte and (aligned) word loads.
5193
5194When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
5195finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
5196load will be used if alignment permits.  Unless bytes accesses are
5197faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
5198may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
5199other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
5200
5201@findex SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
5202@item SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5203Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
5204@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
5205than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
5206handler.
5207
5208When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
5209@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
5210moves.  This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
5211Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
5212cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
5213
5214If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined.  If
5215this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
5216@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
5217
5218@findex DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5219@item DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5220Define this macro to inhibit strength reduction of memory addresses.
5221(On some machines, such strength reduction seems to do harm rather
5222than good.)
5223
5224@findex MOVE_RATIO
5225@item MOVE_RATIO
5226The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
5227which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
5228string move insn or a library call.  Increasing the value will always
5229make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
5230
5231Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
5232@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
5233the number of such sequences.
5234
5235If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
5236
5237@findex MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
5238@item MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5239A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
5240copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
5241will be used.  Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5242than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
5243
5244@findex MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5245@item MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5246A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
5247a load or store used to copy memory is.  Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
5248
5249@findex USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT
5250@item USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5251A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
5252thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5253@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5254
5255@findex USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT
5256@item USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5257A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
5258thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5259@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5260
5261@findex USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT
5262@item USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5263A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
5264thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5265@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5266
5267@findex USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT
5268@item USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5269A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
5270thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5271@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5272
5273@findex USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT
5274@item USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5275A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
5276thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5277@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5278
5279@findex USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT
5280@item USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5281A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
5282thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5283@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5284
5285@findex USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT
5286@item USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5287This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
5288thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5289@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5290
5291@findex USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT
5292@item USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5293This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
5294thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5295@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5296
5297@findex NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5298@item NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5299Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
5300function address than to call an address kept in a register.
5301
5302@findex NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5303@item NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5304Define this macro if it is as good or better for a function to call
5305itself with an explicit address than to call an address kept in a
5306register.
5307@end table
5308
5309@node Scheduling
5310@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
5311
5312The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
5313adjustment in order to produce good code.  GCC provides several target
5314hooks for this purpose.  It is usually enough to define just a few of
5315them: try the first ones in this list first.
5316
5317@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
5318This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever issue
5319at the same time on the target machine.  The default is one.  This value
5320must be constant over the entire compilation.  If you need it to vary
5321depending on what the instructions are, you must use
5322@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
5323@end deftypefn
5324
5325@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
5326This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
5327from the ready list.  It should return the number of insns which can
5328still be issued in the current cycle.  Normally this is
5329@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}}.  You should define this hook if some insns
5330take more machine resources than others, so that fewer insns can follow
5331them in the same cycle.  @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio
5332stream to write any debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level
5333provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{insn} is the
5334instruction that was scheduled.
5335@end deftypefn
5336
5337@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
5338This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the relationship
5339between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the dependence @var{link}.
5340It should return the new value.  The default is to make no adjustment to
5341@var{cost}.  This can be used for example to specify to the scheduler
5342that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
5343data-dependence.
5344@end deftypefn
5345
5346@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
5347This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
5348@var{insn}.  It should return the new priority.  Reduce the priority to
5349execute @var{insn} earlier, increase the priority to execute @var{insn}
5350later.  Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
5351scheduling priorities of insns.
5352@end deftypefn
5353
5354@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
5355This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
5356list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
5357combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
5358@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
5359debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5360@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
5361list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled.  @var{n_readyp} is
5362a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list.  The scheduler
5363reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
5364@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp}-1] and going to @var{ready}[0].  @var{clock}
5365is the timer tick of the scheduler.  You may modify the ready list and
5366the number of ready insns.  The return value is the number of insns that
5367can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}.  See also
5368@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
5369@end deftypefn
5370
5371@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_ready}, @var{clock})
5372Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time.  That
5373function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle.  This one
5374is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
5375@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
5376return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle.  Defining
5377this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
5378scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
5379cycle.  These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
5380@end deftypefn
5381
5382@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
5383This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
5384instructions that are to be scheduled.  @var{file} is either a null
5385pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.  @var{verbose}
5386is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5387@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
5388region that can be live at the same time.  This can be used to allocate
5389scratch space if it is needed, e.g. by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
5390@end deftypefn
5391
5392@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
5393This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
5394instructions that are to be scheduled.  It can be used to perform
5395cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks.  @var{file}
5396is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
5397to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5398@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5399@end deftypefn
5400
5401@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_CYCLE_DISPLAY (int @var{clock}, rtx @var{last})
5402This hook is called in verbose mode only, at the beginning of each pass
5403over a basic block.  It should insert an insn into the chain after
5404@var{last}, which has no effect, but records the value @var{clock} in
5405RTL dumps and assembly output.  Define this hook only if you need this
5406level of detail about what the scheduler is doing.
5407@end deftypefn
5408
5409@node Sections
5410@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
5411@c the above section title is WAY too long.  maybe cut the part between
5412@c the (...)?  --mew 10feb93
5413
5414An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
5415data.  In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
5416section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
5417section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
5418section}, which holds uninitialized data.  Some systems have other kinds
5419of sections.
5420
5421The compiler must tell the assembler when to switch sections.  These
5422macros control what commands to output to tell the assembler this.  You
5423can also define additional sections.
5424
5425@table @code
5426@findex TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5427@item TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5428A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5429assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
5430Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
5431
5432@findex TEXT_SECTION
5433@item TEXT_SECTION
5434A C statement that switches to the default section containing instructions.
5435Normally this is not needed, as simply defining @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
5436is enough.  The MIPS port uses this to sort all functions after all data
5437declarations.
5438
5439@findex DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5440@item DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5441A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5442assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
5443data.  Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
5444
5445@findex SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5446@item SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5447If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5448containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5449shared data.  If not defined, @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP} will be used.
5450
5451@findex BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5452@item BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5453If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5454containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5455uninitialized global data.  If not defined, and neither
5456@code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
5457uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
5458@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
5459used.
5460
5461@findex SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5462@item SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5463If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5464containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5465uninitialized global shared data.  If not defined, and
5466@code{BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP} is, the latter will be used.
5467
5468@findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5469@item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5470If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5471containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5472initialization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5473not exist.
5474
5475@findex FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5476@item FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5477If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5478containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5479finalization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5480not exist.
5481
5482@findex CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION
5483@item CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
5484If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
5485via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
5486the text section.  This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
5487@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
5488to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
5489sections.  By default, this macro uses a simple function call.  Some
5490ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
5491registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
5492constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
5493
5494@findex FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5495@item FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5496If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
5497arbitrary boundary.  This is used to force all fragments of the
5498@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
5499and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
5500
5501@findex EXTRA_SECTIONS
5502@findex in_text
5503@findex in_data
5504@item EXTRA_SECTIONS
5505A list of names for sections other than the standard two, which are
5506@code{in_text} and @code{in_data}.  You need not define this macro
5507on a system with no other sections (that GCC needs to use).
5508
5509@findex EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5510@findex text_section
5511@findex data_section
5512@item EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5513One or more functions to be defined in @file{varasm.c}.  These
5514functions should do jobs analogous to those of @code{text_section} and
5515@code{data_section}, for your additional sections.  Do not define this
5516macro if you do not define @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}.
5517
5518@findex READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5519@item READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5520On most machines, read-only variables, constants, and jump tables are
5521placed in the text section.  If this is not the case on your machine,
5522this macro should be defined to be the name of a function (either
5523@code{data_section} or a function defined in @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}) that
5524switches to the section to be used for read-only items.
5525
5526If these items should be placed in the text section, this macro should
5527not be defined.
5528
5529@findex SELECT_SECTION
5530@item SELECT_SECTION (@var{exp}, @var{reloc}, @var{align})
5531A C statement or statements to switch to the appropriate section for
5532output of @var{exp}.  You can assume that @var{exp} is either a
5533@code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of some sort.  @var{reloc}
5534indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time
5535relocations.  Bit 1 is set when variable contains local relocations
5536only, while bit 2 is set for global relocations.
5537Select the section by calling @code{text_section} or one
5538of the alternatives for other sections.  @var{align} is the constant
5539alignment in bits.
5540
5541Do not define this macro if you put all read-only variables and
5542constants in the read-only data section (usually the text section).
5543
5544@findex SELECT_RTX_SECTION
5545@item SELECT_RTX_SECTION (@var{mode}, @var{rtx}, @var{align})
5546A C statement or statements to switch to the appropriate section for
5547output of @var{rtx} in mode @var{mode}.  You can assume that @var{rtx}
5548is some kind of constant in RTL@.  The argument @var{mode} is redundant
5549except in the case of a @code{const_int} rtx.  Select the section by
5550calling @code{text_section} or one of the alternatives for other
5551sections.  @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
5552
5553Do not define this macro if you put all constants in the read-only
5554data section.
5555
5556@findex JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5557@item JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5558Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
5559tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
5560section, along with the assembler instructions.  Otherwise, the
5561readonly data section is used.
5562
5563This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
5564
5565@findex ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
5566@item ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (@var{decl})
5567Define this macro if references to a symbol or a constant must be
5568treated differently depending on something about the variable or
5569function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
5570
5571The macro definition, if any, is executed under two circumstances.  One
5572is immediately after the rtl for @var{decl} that represents a variable
5573or a function has been created and stored in @code{DECL_RTL
5574(@var{decl})}.  The value of the rtl will be a @code{mem} whose address
5575is a @code{symbol_ref}.  The other is immediately after the rtl for
5576@var{decl} that represents a constant has been created and stored in
5577@code{TREE_CST_RTL (@var{decl})}.  The macro is called once for each
5578distinct constant in a source file.
5579
5580@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
5581The usual thing for this macro to do is to record a flag in the
5582@code{symbol_ref} (such as @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}) or to store a
5583modified name string in the @code{symbol_ref} (if one bit is not enough
5584information).
5585
5586@findex STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
5587@item STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (@var{var}, @var{sym_name})
5588Decode @var{sym_name} and store the real name part in @var{var}, sans
5589the characters that encode section info.  Define this macro if
5590@code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} alters the symbol's name string.
5591
5592@findex UNIQUE_SECTION
5593@item UNIQUE_SECTION (@var{decl}, @var{reloc})
5594A C statement to build up a unique section name, expressed as a
5595@code{STRING_CST} node, and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
5596@var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} requires
5597link-time relocations.  If you do not define this macro, GCC will use
5598the symbol name prefixed by @samp{.} as the section name.  Note - this
5599macro can now be called for uninitialized data items as well as
5600initialized data and functions.
5601@end table
5602
5603@node PIC
5604@section Position Independent Code
5605@cindex position independent code
5606@cindex PIC
5607
5608This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
5609independent code.  Simply defining these macros is not enough to
5610generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the macros
5611@code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as
5612well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}.  You must modify the definition of
5613@samp{movsi} to do something appropriate when the source operand
5614contains a symbolic address.  You may also need to alter the handling of
5615switch statements so that they use relative addresses.
5616@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
5617@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
5618
5619@table @code
5620@findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
5621@item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
5622The register number of the register used to address a table of static
5623data addresses in memory.  In some cases this register is defined by a
5624processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@.  When this macro
5625is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
5626pointer and frame pointer registers.  If this macro is not defined, it
5627is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
5628necessary).  Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
5629when @code{flag_pic} is true).
5630
5631@findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
5632@item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
5633Define this macro if the register defined by
5634@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls.  Do not define
5635this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
5636
5637@findex FINALIZE_PIC
5638@item FINALIZE_PIC
5639By generating position-independent code, when two different programs (A
5640and B) share a common library (libC.a), the text of the library can be
5641shared whether or not the library is linked at the same address for both
5642programs.  In some of these environments, position-independent code
5643requires not only the use of different addressing modes, but also
5644special code to enable the use of these addressing modes.
5645
5646The @code{FINALIZE_PIC} macro serves as a hook to emit these special
5647codes once the function is being compiled into assembly code, but not
5648before.  (It is not done before, because in the case of compiling an
5649inline function, it would lead to multiple PIC prologues being
5650included in functions which used inline functions and were compiled to
5651assembly language.)
5652
5653@findex LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P
5654@item LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
5655A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
5656operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
5657You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
5658check this.  You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
5659check it either.  You need not define this macro if all constants
5660(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
5661position independent code.
5662@end table
5663
5664@node Assembler Format
5665@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
5666
5667This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
5668to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
5669instructions do.
5670
5671@menu
5672* File Framework::       Structural information for the assembler file.
5673* Data Output::          Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
5674* Uninitialized Data::   Output of uninitialized variables.
5675* Label Output::         Output and generation of labels.
5676* Initialization::       General principles of initialization
5677			   and termination routines.
5678* Macros for Initialization::
5679			 Specific macros that control the handling of
5680			   initialization and termination routines.
5681* Instruction Output::   Output of actual instructions.
5682* Dispatch Tables::      Output of jump tables.
5683* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
5684* Alignment Output::     Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
5685@end menu
5686
5687@node File Framework
5688@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
5689@cindex assembler format
5690@cindex output of assembler code
5691
5692@c prevent bad page break with this line
5693This describes the overall framework of an assembler file.
5694
5695@table @code
5696@findex ASM_FILE_START
5697@item ASM_FILE_START (@var{stream})
5698A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
5699some appropriate text to go at the start of an assembler file.
5700
5701Normally this macro is defined to output a line containing
5702@samp{#NO_APP}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
5703assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it can save time by not
5704checking for certain assembler constructs.
5705
5706On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
5707see @file{attasm.h}.
5708
5709@findex ASM_FILE_END
5710@item ASM_FILE_END (@var{stream})
5711A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
5712some appropriate text to go at the end of an assembler file.
5713
5714If this macro is not defined, the default is to output nothing
5715special at the end of the file.  Most systems don't require any
5716definition.
5717
5718On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
5719see @file{attasm.h}.
5720
5721@findex ASM_COMMENT_START
5722@item ASM_COMMENT_START
5723A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
5724assembler language.  The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
5725the end of the line.
5726
5727@findex ASM_APP_ON
5728@item ASM_APP_ON
5729A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
5730statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
5731@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
5732assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
5733that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
5734
5735@findex ASM_APP_OFF
5736@item ASM_APP_OFF
5737A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
5738statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
5739@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
5740time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
5741
5742@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
5743@item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
5744A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
5745which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
5746the stdio stream @var{stream}.
5747
5748This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
5749for the file format in use is appropriate.
5750
5751@findex OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING
5752@item OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
5753A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
5754@var{stream}.  If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
5755in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
5756the assembler source.  So you can use it to canonicalize the format
5757of the filename using this macro.
5758
5759@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE
5760@item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
5761A C statement to output DBX or SDB debugging information before code
5762for line number @var{line} of the current source file to the
5763stdio stream @var{stream}.
5764
5765This macro need not be defined if the standard form of debugging
5766information for the debugger in use is appropriate.
5767
5768@findex ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT
5769@item ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
5770A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
5771@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}.  If this
5772macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
5773
5774@findex OBJC_PROLOGUE
5775@item OBJC_PROLOGUE
5776A C statement to output any assembler statements which are required to
5777precede any Objective-C object definitions or message sending.  The
5778statement is executed only when compiling an Objective-C program.
5779@end table
5780
5781@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int @var{align})
5782Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}.  The section
5783should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
5784of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}.  If @var{align}
5785is nonzero, it contains an alignment in bytes to be used for the section,
5786otherwise some target default should be used.  Only targets that must
5787specify an alignment within the section directive need pay attention to
5788@var{align} -- we will still use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}.
5789@end deftypefn
5790
5791@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
5792This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
5793@end deftypefn
5794
5795@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
5796Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
5797based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
5798declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations.  @var{decl} may be
5799 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
5800
5801The default version if this function handles choosing code vs data,
5802read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}.  You should only
5803need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
5804set via @code{__attribute__}.
5805@end deftypefn
5806
5807@need 2000
5808@node Data Output
5809@subsection Output of Data
5810
5811
5812@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
5813@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
5814@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
5815@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
5816@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
5817@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
5818@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
5819@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
5820@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
5821These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
5822of integer object.  The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
5823byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
5824aligned two-byte object, and so on.  Any of the hooks may be
5825@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
5826
5827The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
5828followed immediately by the object's initial value.  In most cases,
5829the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
5830@end deftypevr
5831
5832@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
5833The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
5834integer object.  @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
5835in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned.  The
5836function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
5837object.  If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
5838split the object into smaller parts.
5839
5840The default implementation of this hook will use the
5841@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
5842when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
5843@end deftypefn
5844
5845@table @code
5846@findex OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
5847@item OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
5848A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
5849@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
5850@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}.  This may be used to
5851allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
5852
5853If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
5854@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed.  If it
5855prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
5856@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
5857
5858@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII
5859@item ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
5860A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
5861instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
5862bytes at @var{ptr}.  @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
5863@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
5864
5865If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
5866Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
5867@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
5868
5869@findex ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC
5870@item ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
5871A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
5872@var{decl}.  This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
5873is defined, and is otherwise unused.
5874
5875@findex CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
5876@item CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
5877You may define this macro as a C expression.  You should define the
5878expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
5879pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
5880GCC should output the constant pool after the function.  If you do
5881not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
5882pool before the function.
5883
5884@findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE
5885@item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
5886A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
5887constant pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving
5888the name of the function.  Should the return type of the function
5889be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size}
5890is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
5891immediately after this call.
5892
5893If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
5894not be defined.
5895
5896@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY
5897@item ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
5898A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
5899constant pool, if it needs special treatment.  (This macro need not do
5900anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
5901
5902The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
5903assembler code on.  @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
5904output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
5905@samp{const_int}).  @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
5906@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
5907alignment.
5908
5909The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
5910the address of this pool entry.  The definition of this macro is
5911responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
5912Here is how to do this:
5913
5914@example
5915ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
5916@end example
5917
5918When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
5919@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}.  This will prevent the same pool
5920entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
5921
5922You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
5923
5924@findex CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P
5925@item CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P (@var{exp})
5926Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if the constant
5927@var{exp}, of type @code{tree}, should be output after the code for a
5928function.  The compiler will normally output all constants before the
5929function; you need not define this macro if this is OK@.
5930
5931@findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE
5932@item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
5933A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
5934pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
5935function.  Should the return type of the function be required, you can
5936obtain it via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
5937constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
5938
5939If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
5940define this macro.
5941
5942@findex IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR
5943@item IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C})
5944Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
5945used as a logical line separator by the assembler.
5946
5947If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
5948the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
5949@end table
5950
5951@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
5952@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
5953These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
5954assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions.  If not overridden, they
5955default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
5956@end deftypevr
5957
5958  These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
5959of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
5960
5961@table @code
5962@item REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5963@itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5964@itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5965@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE
5966@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE
5967@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE
5968These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the target's
5969floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in the array of
5970@code{long int} whose address is @var{l}.  The number of elements in the
5971output array is determined by the size of the desired target floating
5972point data type: 32 bits of it go in each @code{long int} array
5973element.  Each array element holds 32 bits of the result, even if
5974@code{long int} is wider than 32 bits on the host machine.
5975
5976The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
5977using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
5978machine's memory.
5979
5980@item REAL_VALUE_TO_DECIMAL (@var{x}, @var{format}, @var{string})
5981@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_DECIMAL
5982This macro converts @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to a
5983decimal number and stores it as a string into @var{string}.
5984You must pass, as @var{string}, the address of a long enough block
5985of space to hold the result.
5986
5987The argument @var{format} is a @code{printf}-specification that serves
5988as a suggestion for how to format the output string.
5989@end table
5990
5991@node Uninitialized Data
5992@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
5993
5994Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
5995outputting a single uninitialized variable.
5996
5997@table @code
5998@findex ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON
5999@item ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6000A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6001@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
6002@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
6003is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6004
6005Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6006output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6007assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6008
6009This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6010common global variables are output.
6011
6012@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON
6013@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6014Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
6015separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
6016place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
6017handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
6018as the number of bits.
6019
6020@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON
6021@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6022Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
6023variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6024is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6025in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
6026@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}.  Define this macro when you need to see
6027the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6028
6029@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON
6030@item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6031If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, except that it
6032is used when @var{name} is shared.  If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6033will be used.
6034
6035@findex ASM_OUTPUT_BSS
6036@item ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6037A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6038@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
6039@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
6040is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6041
6042Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
6043defining this macro.  If unable, use the expression
6044@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
6045before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
6046the name, and a newline.
6047
6048This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized global
6049variables are output.  This macro exists to properly support languages like
6050C++ which do not have @code{common} data.  However, this macro currently
6051is not defined for all targets.  If this macro and
6052@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are not defined then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6053or @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} or
6054@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON} is used.
6055
6056@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS
6057@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6058Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
6059separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
6060place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
6061handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
6062as the number of bits.
6063
6064Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
6065@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
6066
6067@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS
6068@item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6069If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, except that it
6070is used when @var{name} is shared.  If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}
6071will be used.
6072
6073@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL
6074@item ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6075A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6076@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
6077@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
6078is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6079
6080Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6081output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6082assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6083
6084This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6085static variables are output.
6086
6087@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL
6088@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6089Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
6090separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
6091place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
6092handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
6093as the number of bits.
6094
6095@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL
6096@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6097Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
6098variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6099is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6100in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
6101@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}.  Define this macro when you need to see
6102the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6103
6104@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL
6105@item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6106If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, except that it
6107is used when @var{name} is shared.  If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}
6108will be used.
6109@end table
6110
6111@node Label Output
6112@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
6113
6114@c prevent bad page break with this line
6115This is about outputting labels.
6116
6117@table @code
6118@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL
6119@findex assemble_name
6120@item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6121A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6122@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
6123Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6124output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6125assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6126
6127@findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME
6128@item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6129A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6130@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
6131function which is being defined.  This macro is responsible for
6132outputting the label definition (perhaps using
6133@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).  The argument @var{decl} is the
6134@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
6135
6136If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
6137usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6138
6139@findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE
6140@item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6141A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6142@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
6143which is being defined.  The argument @var{name} is the name of the
6144function.  The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
6145representing the function.
6146
6147If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
6148
6149@findex ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME
6150@item ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6151A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6152@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
6153initialized variable which is being defined.  This macro must output the
6154label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).  The argument
6155@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
6156
6157If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
6158usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6159
6160@findex ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL
6161@item ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
6162A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6163@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
6164for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
6165
6166If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6167nothing.
6168
6169@findex  ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT
6170@item ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
6171A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
6172once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
6173chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
6174initializer.  This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
6175something about the size of the object.
6176
6177If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6178nothing.
6179
6180@findex ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
6181@item ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6182A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6183@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
6184that is, available for reference from other files.  Use the expression
6185@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
6186itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
6187for making that name global, and a newline.
6188
6189@findex ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
6190@item ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6191A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6192@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
6193that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
6194no other definition is available.  Use the expression
6195@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
6196itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
6197for making that name weak, and a newline.
6198
6199If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
6200support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
6201macro.
6202
6203@findex ASM_WEAKEN_DECL
6204@item ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6205Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
6206@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
6207or variable decl.  If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
6208should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
6209defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6210@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
6211to make @var{name} weak.
6212
6213@findex SUPPORTS_WEAK
6214@item SUPPORTS_WEAK
6215A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
6216
6217If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
6218definition.  If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
6219is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is
6220@samp{0}.  Define this macro if you want to control weak symbol support
6221with a compiler flag such as @option{-melf}.
6222
6223@findex MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
6224@item MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY
6225A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
6226public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
6227be discarded by the linker.  Define this macro if your object file
6228format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
6229section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
6230requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
6231
6232@findex SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6233@item SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6234A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
6235semantics.
6236
6237If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
6238definition.  If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
6239definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.  Define this macro if
6240you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
6241setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
6242be emitted as one-only.
6243
6244@findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL
6245@item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
6246A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6247@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
6248symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
6249not defined.  The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
6250declaration.
6251
6252This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6253The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6254
6255@findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
6256@item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (@var{stream}, @var{symref})
6257A C statement (sans semicolon) to output on @var{stream} an assembler
6258pseudo-op to declare a library function name external.  The name of the
6259library function is given by @var{symref}, which has type @code{rtx} and
6260is a @code{symbol_ref}.
6261
6262This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6263The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6264
6265@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF
6266@item ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6267A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6268@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
6269@var{name}.  This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
6270is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
6271systems.  This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
6272
6273@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF
6274@item ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
6275A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
6276@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}.  If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
6277will be used to output the name of the symbol.  This macro may be used
6278to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
6279encoded by @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
6280
6281@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF
6282@item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
6283A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
6284result of ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL.  If not defined,
6285@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
6286This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
6287specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
6288when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address
6289is being taken.
6290
6291@findex ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL
6292@item ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6293A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
6294name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
6295
6296It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
6297used for user-level functions and variables.  Otherwise, certain programs
6298will have name conflicts with internal labels.
6299
6300It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
6301object file.  Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
6302should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
6303beginning of a label has this effect.  You should find out what
6304convention your system uses, and follow it.
6305
6306The usual definition of this macro is as follows:
6307
6308@example
6309fprintf (@var{stream}, "L%s%d:\n", @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6310@end example
6311
6312@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL
6313@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6314A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
6315label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
6316@var{num}.  This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
6317may need to be treated differently than branch target labels.  On some
6318systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
6319bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
6320bundles.
6321
6322If this macro is not defined, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL} will be
6323used.
6324
6325@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALTERNATE_LABEL_NAME
6326@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALTERNATE_LABEL_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{string})
6327A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} the string
6328@var{string}.
6329
6330The default definition of this macro is as follows:
6331
6332@example
6333fprintf (@var{stream}, "%s:\n", LABEL_ALTERNATE_NAME (INSN))
6334@end example
6335
6336@findex ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL
6337@item ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6338A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
6339is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
6340
6341This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
6342produce the output that @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL} would produce
6343with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
6344
6345If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
6346output the rest of the string unchanged.  It is often convenient for
6347@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way.  If the
6348string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
6349to output the string, and may change it.  (Of course,
6350@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
6351you should know what it does on your machine.)
6352
6353@findex ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME
6354@item ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
6355A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
6356@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
6357@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
6358added.  Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
6359
6360The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
6361produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
6362@var{name}.  Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
6363assembler code.  The argument @var{number} is different each time this
6364macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
6365internal static variables in different scopes.
6366
6367Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
6368conflict with the user's own symbols.  Most assemblers allow periods
6369or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
6370between the name and the number will suffice.
6371
6372@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF
6373@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6374A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6375which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
6376
6377@findex SET_ASM_OP
6378If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6379correct for most systems.
6380
6381@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS
6382@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
6383A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6384which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
6385to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}.  This macro will
6386be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
6387the tree nodes are available.
6388
6389@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL
6390@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL (@var{stream}, @var{symbol}, @var{high}, @var{low})
6391A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6392which defines (equates) the symbol @var{symbol} to have a value equal to
6393the difference of the two symbols @var{high} and @var{low},
6394i.e.@: @var{high} minus @var{low}.  GCC guarantees that the symbols @var{high}
6395and @var{low} are already known by the assembler so that the difference
6396resolves into a constant.
6397
6398@findex SET_ASM_OP
6399If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6400correct for most systems.
6401
6402@findex ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS
6403@item ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6404A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6405which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6406@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
6407an undefined weak symbol.
6408
6409Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
6410@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
6411
6412@findex OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL
6413@item OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
6414Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
6415Objective-C methods.
6416
6417The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
6418class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}).  For methods in categories, the name of
6419the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
6420@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
6421
6422These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
6423the method's selector is not present in the name.  Therefore, particular
6424systems define other ways of computing names.
6425
6426@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
6427buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
6428@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
642950 characters extra.
6430
6431The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
6432method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
6433@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
6434in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
6435
6436On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
6437macro to provide more human-readable names.
6438
6439@findex ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE
6440@item ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6441A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6442@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6443Objective-C class reference.  This is only needed for targets whose
6444linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6445
6446@findex ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE
6447@item ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6448A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6449@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6450unresolved Objective-C class reference.  This is only needed for targets
6451whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6452@end table
6453
6454@node Initialization
6455@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
6456@cindex initialization routines
6457@cindex termination routines
6458@cindex constructors, output of
6459@cindex destructors, output of
6460
6461The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
6462(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
6463data in the program when the program is started.  These functions need
6464to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
6465@code{main} is called.
6466
6467Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
6468@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
6469terminates.
6470
6471To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
6472must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
6473be called at the appropriate time.  When you port the compiler to a new
6474system, you need to specify how to do this.
6475
6476There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
6477initialization and termination functions.  Each way has two variants.
6478Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
6479
6480@findex __CTOR_LIST__
6481@findex __DTOR_LIST__
6482The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
6483initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
6484termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
6485
6486Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
64870, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
6488the environment).  This is followed by a series of zero or more function
6489pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
6490pointer containing zero.
6491
6492Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
6493@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
6494time and exit time.  Constructors are called in reverse order of the
6495list; destructors in forward order.
6496
6497The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
6498formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections.  A section is set
6499aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
6500Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}.  Each
6501object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
6502the constructor section to point to that function.  The linker
6503accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
6504Termination functions are handled similarly.
6505
6506This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
6507@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined.  A target that does not
6508support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
6509constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
6510and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
6511
6512When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
6513upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called.  On systems that
6514support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
6515parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section.  The
6516program is linked by the @code{gcc} driver like this:
6517
6518@example
6519ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
6520@end example
6521
6522The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
6523section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}.  Likewise
6524for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section.  Normally these
6525files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
6526are provided by GCC for a few targets.
6527
6528The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
6529compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}.  They contain, among other things, code
6530fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
6531to routines in the @code{.text} section.  The linker will pull all parts
6532of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
6533that invokes the routines we need at startup.
6534
6535To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
6536macro properly.
6537
6538If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
6539@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
6540entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
6541it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
6542after the function prologue.  The @code{__main} function is defined
6543in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
6544
6545In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
6546two variants.  In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
6547and an `a.out' format must be used.  In this case,
6548@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
6549entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
6550and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
6551code as its value.  The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
6552the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
6553placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
6554a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
6555@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly.  Since no init
6556section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
6557the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
6558the initialization process.
6559
6560The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
6561This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
6562file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@.  In
6563this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
6564termination functions are recognized simply by their names.  This requires
6565an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}.  This program
6566pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
6567the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
6568initialization and termination functions.  These functions are called
6569via @code{__main} as described above.  In order to use this method,
6570@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
6571
6572@ifinfo
6573The following section describes the specific macros that control and
6574customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
6575@end ifinfo
6576
6577@node Macros for Initialization
6578@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
6579
6580Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
6581and termination functions:
6582
6583@table @code
6584@findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6585@item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6586If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
6587operation to identify the following data as initialization code.  If not
6588defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  When you are
6589using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
6590macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
6591run the initialization functions.
6592
6593@item HAS_INIT_SECTION
6594@findex HAS_INIT_SECTION
6595If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
6596This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
6597on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
6598be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6599
6600@item LD_INIT_SWITCH
6601@findex LD_INIT_SWITCH
6602If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
6603the following symbol is an initialization routine.
6604
6605@item LD_FINI_SWITCH
6606@findex LD_FINI_SWITCH
6607If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
6608the following symbol is a finalization routine.
6609
6610@item COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
6611If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
6612automatically called when a shared library is loaded.  The function
6613should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
6614the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
6615function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
6616
6617This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
6618shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
6619exception tables embedded in the code.
6620
6621@item COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
6622If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
6623automatically called when a shared library is unloaded.  The function
6624should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
6625the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
6626function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
6627
6628@item INVOKE__main
6629@findex INVOKE__main
6630If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
6631@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.  This macro should be defined for systems
6632where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
6633useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
6634
6635@item SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
6636@findex SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
6637If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
6638compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
6639of objects.  If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
6640encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
6641@end table
6642
6643@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
6644This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
6645collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
6646It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
6647@end deftypefn
6648
6649@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
6650If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
6651the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
6652
6653Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
6654no arguments and with no return value.  If the target supports initialization
6655priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
6656otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
6657
6658If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
6659be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
6660target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
6661is not defined.
6662@end deftypefn
6663
6664@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
6665This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
6666functions rather than initialization functions.
6667@end deftypefn
6668
6669If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
6670generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
6671
6672If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
6673constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
6674an object file for constructor functions to be called.
6675
6676On certain kinds of systems, you can define these macros to make
6677@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
6678
6679@table @code
6680@findex OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
6681@item OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
6682Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
6683object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
6684object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
6685
6686@findex OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
6687@item OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
6688Define this macro if the system uses ROSE format object files, so that
6689@command{collect2} can assume this format and scan object files directly
6690for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
6691
6692These macros are effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
6693part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
6694
6695@findex REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
6696@item REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
6697Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
6698to execute @command{nm}.  The default is to search the path normally for
6699@command{nm}.
6700
6701If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
6702dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
6703these macros to enable support for running initialization and
6704termination functions in shared libraries:
6705
6706@findex LDD_SUFFIX
6707@item LDD_SUFFIX
6708Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
6709which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
6710
6711@findex PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT
6712@item PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
6713Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
6714of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  @var{ptr} is a variable
6715of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
6716from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
6717code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
6718line.  Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
6719@end table
6720
6721@node Instruction Output
6722@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
6723
6724@c prevent bad page break with this line
6725This describes assembler instruction output.
6726
6727@table @code
6728@findex REGISTER_NAMES
6729@item REGISTER_NAMES
6730A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
6731registers, each one as a C string constant.  This is what translates
6732register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
6733
6734@findex ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
6735@item ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
6736If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
6737and a register number.  This macro defines additional names for hard
6738registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
6739to registers using alternate names.
6740
6741@findex ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE
6742@item ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
6743Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
6744requires different names for the machine instructions.
6745
6746The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
6747assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}.  The
6748macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
6749points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
6750written in the machine description.  The definition should output the
6751opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
6752increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
6753so that it will not be output twice.
6754
6755In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
6756name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
6757that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
6758care of the substitution yourself.  Just be sure to increment
6759@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
6760
6761@findex recog_data.operand
6762If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
6763elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
6764
6765If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
6766in the usual way.
6767
6768@findex FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN
6769@item FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
6770If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
6771assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
6772they will be output differently.
6773
6774Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
6775extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
6776elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
6777The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
6778template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
6779by changing the contents of the vector.
6780
6781This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
6782file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
6783can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
6784as with rearranged operands).  Naturally, variations in assembler
6785syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
6786writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
6787
6788If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
6789
6790@findex FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
6791@item FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
6792If defined, @code{FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN} will be called on each
6793@code{CODE_LABEL}.  In that case, @var{opvec} will be a null pointer and
6794@var{noperands} will be zero.
6795
6796@findex PRINT_OPERAND
6797@item PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
6798A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
6799assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}.  @var{x} is an
6800RTL expression.
6801
6802@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
6803of printing the operand.  It is used when identical operands must be
6804printed differently depending on the context.  @var{code} comes from
6805the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
6806operand.  If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
6807@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
6808@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
6809
6810@findex reg_names
6811If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
6812The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
6813@code{char *[]}.  @code{reg_names} is initialized from
6814@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
6815
6816When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
6817(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
6818with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
6819@var{code}.
6820
6821@findex PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P
6822@item PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
6823A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
6824punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro.  If
6825@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
6826punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
6827in this way.
6828
6829@findex PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS
6830@item PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
6831A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
6832assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
6833whose address is @var{x}.  @var{x} is an RTL expression.
6834
6835@cindex @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
6836On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
6837section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the macro
6838@code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
6839@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  @xref{Assembler Format}.
6840
6841@findex DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND
6842@findex dbr_sequence_length
6843@item DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND(@var{file})
6844A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
6845been output.  If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
6846determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
6847currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
6848or whatever.
6849
6850Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
6851reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
6852explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
6853
6854@findex final_sequence
6855Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
6856prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
6857(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
6858found.)  The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
6859processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
6860being output.
6861
6862@findex REGISTER_PREFIX
6863@findex LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
6864@findex USER_LABEL_PREFIX
6865@findex IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
6866@findex asm_fprintf
6867@item REGISTER_PREFIX
6868@itemx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
6869@itemx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
6870@itemx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
6871If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
6872@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
6873@file{final.c}).  These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
6874support multiple assembler formats.  In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
6875files can define these macros differently.
6876
6877@item ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS(@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
6878@findex ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS
6879If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
6880statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
6881the @code{asm_fprintf} function.  This allows targets to define extra
6882printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
6883statements.  Note that upper case letters are reserved for future
6884generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
6885specific code.  The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
6886The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
6887string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
6888upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
6889
6890@findex ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
6891@item ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
6892If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
6893different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
6894numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
6895first variant.
6896
6897If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
6898@smallexample
6899@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
6900@end smallexample
6901@noindent
6902in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
6903first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}.  This construct outputs
6904@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
6905@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc.  Any special characters
6906within these strings retain their usual meaning.  If there are fewer
6907alternatives within the braces than the value of
6908@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
6909
6910If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
6911@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
6912operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
6913
6914Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
6915@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
6916the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism.  Define
6917@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
6918if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
6919opcodes or operand order.
6920
6921@findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH
6922@item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
6923A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
6924which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
6925The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
6926profiling.
6927
6928@findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP
6929@item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
6930A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
6931which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
6932The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
6933profiling.
6934@end table
6935
6936@node Dispatch Tables
6937@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
6938
6939@c prevent bad page break with this line
6940This concerns dispatch tables.
6941
6942@table @code
6943@cindex dispatch table
6944@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT
6945@item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
6946A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
6947pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
6948@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels.  The
6949definitions of these labels are output using
6950@code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}, and they must be printed in the same
6951way here.  For example,
6952
6953@example
6954fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
6955         @var{value}, @var{rel})
6956@end example
6957
6958You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
6959dispatch table are relative to the table's own address.  If defined, GCC
6960will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
6961@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
6962mode and flags can be read.
6963
6964@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT
6965@item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
6966This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
6967in a dispatch table are absolute.
6968
6969The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
6970@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
6971a label.  @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
6972definition is output using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
6973For example,
6974
6975@example
6976fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
6977@end example
6978
6979@findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL
6980@item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
6981Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
6982specially.  The first three arguments are the same as for
6983@code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}; the fourth argument is the
6984jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
6985@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
6986
6987This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
6988for the table.
6989
6990If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
6991@code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
6992
6993@findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END
6994@item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
6995Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
6996jump-table.  The definition should be a C statement to be executed
6997after the assembler code for the table is written.  It should write
6998the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}.  The argument
6999@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
7000of the preceding label.
7001
7002If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
7003the jump-table.
7004@end table
7005
7006@node Exception Region Output
7007@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
7008
7009@c prevent bad page break with this line
7010
7011This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
7012region.
7013
7014@table @code
7015@findex EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7016@item EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7017If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
7018exception handling frame unwind information.  If not defined, GCC will
7019provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7020@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
7021
7022You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
7023unwind information and the default definition does not work.
7024
7025@findex EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
7026@item EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
7027If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
7028data section even though the target supports named sections.  This
7029might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
7030collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
7031
7032Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
7033also defined.
7034
7035@findex MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7036@item MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7037An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
7038that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
7039
7040@findex DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7041@item DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7042Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
7043information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
7044Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
7045@samp{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @samp{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
7046or @samp{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of
70471.
7048
7049If this macro is defined to 1, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be the default
7050exception handling mechanism; otherwise, @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} will be used by
7051default.
7052
7053If this macro is defined to anything, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be used
7054instead of inline unwinders and @code{__unwind_function} in the non-@code{setjmp} case.
7055
7056@findex DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7057@item DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7058This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
7059function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
7060@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  The definition should be the negative minimum
7061alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
7062minimum alignment otherwise.  @xref{SDB and DWARF}.  Only applicable if
7063the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
7064
7065@end table
7066
7067@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXCEPTION_SECTION ()
7068If defined, a function that switches to the section in which the main
7069exception table is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}).  The default is a
7070function that switches to a section named @code{.gcc_except_table} on
7071machines that support named sections via
7072@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}, otherwise if @option{-fpic} or
7073@option{-fPIC} is in effect, the @code{data_section}, otherwise the
7074@code{readonly_data_section}.
7075@end deftypefn
7076
7077@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EH_FRAME_SECTION ()
7078If defined, a function that switches to the section in which the DWARF 2
7079frame unwind information to be placed (@pxref{Sections}).  The default
7080is a function that outputs a standard GAS section directive, if
7081@code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, or else a data section
7082directive followed by a synthetic label.
7083@end deftypefn
7084
7085@node Alignment Output
7086@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
7087
7088@c prevent bad page break with this line
7089This describes commands for alignment.
7090
7091@table @code
7092@findex JUMP_ALIGN
7093@item JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7094The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
7095a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
7096
7097This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7098to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
7099define the macro.
7100
7101Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7102to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
7103@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7104selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
7105
7106@findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER
7107@item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
7108The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7109a @code{BARRIER}.
7110
7111This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7112to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
7113define the macro.
7114
7115@findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7116@item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7117The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
7118@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}.  This works only if
7119@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7120
7121@findex LOOP_ALIGN
7122@item LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7123The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7124a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
7125
7126This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7127to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
7128define the macro.
7129
7130Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7131to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
7132@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7133selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
7134
7135@findex LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7136@item LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7137The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN}.
7138This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7139
7140@findex LABEL_ALIGN
7141@item LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
7142The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
7143If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
7144the maximum of the specified values is used.
7145
7146Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7147to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
7148@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7149selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
7150
7151@findex LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7152@item LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7153The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}.
7154This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7155
7156@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP
7157@item ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
7158A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7159instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
7160Those bytes should be zero when loaded.  @var{nbytes} will be a C
7161expression of type @code{int}.
7162
7163@findex ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7164@item ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7165Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
7166text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
7167This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
7168produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
7169section.
7170
7171@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN
7172@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
7173A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7174command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7175@var{power} bytes.  @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
7176
7177@findex ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN
7178@item ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
7179A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7180command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7181@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
7182satisfy the alignment request.  @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
7183a C expression of type @code{int}.
7184@end table
7185
7186@need 3000
7187@node Debugging Info
7188@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
7189
7190@c prevent bad page break with this line
7191This describes how to specify debugging information.
7192
7193@menu
7194* All Debuggers::      Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
7195* DBX Options::        Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
7196* DBX Hooks::          Hook macros for varying DBX format.
7197* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
7198* SDB and DWARF::      Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
7199* VMS Debug::          Macros for VMS debug format.
7200@end menu
7201
7202@node All Debuggers
7203@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
7204
7205@c prevent bad page break with this line
7206These macros affect all debugging formats.
7207
7208@table @code
7209@findex DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER
7210@item DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
7211A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
7212register number @var{regno}.  In the default macro provided, the value
7213of this expression will be @var{regno} itself.  But sometimes there are
7214some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
7215versa.  In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
7216compiler and another for DBX@.
7217
7218If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
7219used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
7220consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
7221Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
7222expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
7223
7224If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
7225does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
7226redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
7227
7228@findex DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET
7229@item DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
7230A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
7231variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The default
7232computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
7233gives the offset from the frame-pointer.  This is required for targets
7234that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
7235for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
7236@option{-g} options is used.
7237
7238@findex DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET
7239@item DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
7240A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
7241having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The nominal offset is
7242@var{offset}.
7243
7244@findex PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7245@item PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7246A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
7247produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}.  Define
7248this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
7249debugging output.  Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
7250@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
7251@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
7252
7253When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
7254value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
7255exceptions.  If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined and
7256@code{LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2} is not defined, GCC uses the
7257value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}.  Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
7258defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
7259
7260The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
7261user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
7262@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-1}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff},
7263or @option{-gvms}.
7264@end table
7265
7266@node DBX Options
7267@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
7268
7269@c prevent bad page break with this line
7270These are specific options for DBX output.
7271
7272@table @code
7273@findex DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7274@item DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7275Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
7276in response to the @option{-g} option.
7277
7278@findex XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7279@item XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7280Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
7281in response to the @option{-g} option.  This is a variant of DBX format.
7282
7283@findex DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7284@item DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7285Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
7286GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
7287debugging information is enabled at all).  If you don't define the
7288macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
7289if there is any occasion to.
7290
7291@findex DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7292@item DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7293Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
7294in the text section.
7295
7296@findex ASM_STABS_OP
7297@item ASM_STABS_OP
7298A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7299use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
7300If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used.  This macro
7301applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7302
7303@findex ASM_STABD_OP
7304@item ASM_STABD_OP
7305A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7306use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
7307value is the current location.  If you don't define this macro,
7308@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used.  This macro applies only to DBX debugging
7309information format.
7310
7311@findex ASM_STABN_OP
7312@item ASM_STABN_OP
7313A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7314use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
7315name.  If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used.  This
7316macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7317
7318@findex DBX_NO_XREFS
7319@item DBX_NO_XREFS
7320Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
7321@samp{xs@var{tagname}}.  On some systems, this construct is used to
7322describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
7323On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
7324
7325@findex DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7326@item DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7327A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
7328continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
7329exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters).  On some
7330operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
7331must not be done.  You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
7332with the value zero.  You can override the default splitting-length by
7333defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
7334
7335@findex DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7336@item DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7337Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
7338the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows.  To use
7339a different character instead, define this macro as a character
7340constant for the character you want to use.  Do not define this macro
7341if backslash is correct for your system.
7342
7343@findex DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7344@item DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7345Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
7346outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
7347variable.
7348
7349@findex DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7350@item DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7351The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7352for a typedef.  The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
7353
7354@findex DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7355@item DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7356The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7357for a static variable located in the text section.  DBX format does not
7358provide any ``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_FUN}.
7359
7360@findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7361@item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7362The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7363for a parameter passed in registers.  DBX format does not provide any
7364``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
7365
7366@findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7367@item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7368The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
7369passed in registers.  DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
7370do this.  The default is @code{'P'}.
7371
7372@findex DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7373@item DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7374The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a stack
7375parameter.  The default is @code{'p'}.
7376
7377@findex DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7378@item DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7379Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
7380arguments should precede the assembler code for the function.  Normally,
7381in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
7382code.
7383
7384@findex DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7385@item DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7386Define this macro if the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol for a block should
7387precede the debugging information for variables and functions defined in
7388that block.  Normally, in DBX format, the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol comes
7389first.
7390
7391@findex DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7392@item DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7393Define this macro if the value of a symbol describing the scope of a
7394block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be relative to the start
7395of the enclosing function.  Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
7396
7397@findex DBX_USE_BINCL
7398@item DBX_USE_BINCL
7399Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
7400@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems.  This
7401macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
7402number and a type number within the file.  Normally, GCC does not
7403generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
7404number for a type number.
7405@end table
7406
7407@node DBX Hooks
7408@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
7409
7410@c prevent bad page break with this line
7411These are hooks for DBX format.
7412
7413@table @code
7414@findex DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC
7415@item DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7416Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
7417information for the start of a scope level for variable names.  The
7418argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
7419@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
7420
7421@findex DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC
7422@item DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7423Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
7424
7425@findex DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN
7426@item DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
7427Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
7428output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
7429
7430@findex DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM
7431@item DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7432Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
7433output an enumeration type.  The definition should be a C statement
7434(sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information to @var{stream}
7435for the type @var{type}.
7436
7437@findex DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END
7438@item DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END (@var{stream}, @var{function})
7439Define this macro if the target machine requires special output at the
7440end of the debugging information for a function.  The definition should
7441be a C statement (sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information
7442to @var{stream}.  @var{function} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} node for
7443the function.
7444
7445@findex DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES
7446@item DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES (@var{syms})
7447Define this macro if you need to control the order of output of the
7448standard data types at the beginning of compilation.  The argument
7449@var{syms} is a @code{tree} which is a chain of all the predefined
7450global symbols, including names of data types.
7451
7452Normally, DBX output starts with definitions of the types for integers
7453and characters, followed by all the other predefined types of the
7454particular language in no particular order.
7455
7456On some machines, it is necessary to output different particular types
7457first.  To do this, define @code{DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES} to output
7458those symbols in the necessary order.  Any predefined types that you
7459don't explicitly output will be output afterward in no particular order.
7460
7461Be careful not to define this macro so that it works only for C@.  There
7462are no global variables to access most of the built-in types, because
7463another language may have another set of types.  The way to output a
7464particular type is to look through @var{syms} to see if you can find it.
7465Here is an example:
7466
7467@smallexample
7468@{
7469  tree decl;
7470  for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
7471    if (!strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl)),
7472                 "long int"))
7473      dbxout_symbol (decl);
7474  @dots{}
7475@}
7476@end smallexample
7477
7478@noindent
7479This does nothing if the expected type does not exist.
7480
7481See the function @code{init_decl_processing} in @file{c-decl.c} to find
7482the names to use for all the built-in C types.
7483
7484Here is another way of finding a particular type:
7485
7486@c this is still overfull.  --mew 10feb93
7487@smallexample
7488@{
7489  tree decl;
7490  for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
7491    if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL
7492        && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
7493            == INTEGER_CST)
7494        && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == 16
7495        && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
7496@group
7497      /* @r{This must be @code{unsigned short}.}  */
7498      dbxout_symbol (decl);
7499  @dots{}
7500@}
7501@end group
7502@end smallexample
7503
7504@findex NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
7505@item NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
7506Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
7507@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
7508On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
7509disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
7510
7511@end table
7512
7513@node File Names and DBX
7514@subsection File Names in DBX Format
7515
7516@c prevent bad page break with this line
7517This describes file names in DBX format.
7518
7519@table @code
7520@findex DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
7521@item DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
7522Define this if DBX wants to have the current directory recorded in each
7523object file.
7524
7525Note that the working directory is always recorded if GDB extensions are
7526enabled.
7527
7528@findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME
7529@item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7530A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7531@var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
7532file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
7533This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
7534
7535This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7536for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7537
7538@findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
7539@item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7540A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7541@var{stream} which indicates that the current directory during
7542compilation is named @var{name}.
7543
7544This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7545for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7546
7547@findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
7548@item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7549A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
7550compilation of the main source file @var{name}.
7551
7552If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
7553of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
7554
7555@findex DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7556@item DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7557A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7558@var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the current source
7559file.  This output is generated each time input shifts to a different
7560source file as a result of @samp{#include}, the end of an included file,
7561or a @samp{#line} command.
7562
7563This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7564for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7565@end table
7566
7567@need 2000
7568@node SDB and DWARF
7569@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
7570
7571@c prevent bad page break with this line
7572Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
7573
7574@table @code
7575@findex SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
7576@item SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
7577Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
7578for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
7579
7580@findex DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7581@item DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7582Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf format debugging output
7583in response to the @option{-g} option.
7584
7585@findex DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
7586@item DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
7587Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
7588debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
7589
7590To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
7591define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
7592@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
7593prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
7594as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
7595
7596@findex DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
7597@item DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
7598Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
7599Dwarf 2 frame information.  If @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}
7600(@pxref{Exception Region Output} is nonzero, GCC will output this
7601information not matter how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
7602
7603@findex LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
7604@item LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
7605Define this macro if the linker does not work with Dwarf version 2.
7606Normally, if the user specifies only @option{-ggdb} GCC will use Dwarf
7607version 2 if available; this macro disables this.  See the description
7608of the @code{PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE} macro for more details.
7609
7610@findex DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
7611@item DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
7612By default, the Dwarf 2 debugging information generator will generate a
7613label to mark the beginning of the text section.  If it is better simply
7614to use the name of the text section itself, rather than an explicit label,
7615to indicate the beginning of the text section, define this macro to zero.
7616
7617@findex DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
7618@item DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
7619Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
7620line debug info sections.  This will result in much more compact line number
7621tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
7622
7623@findex PUT_SDB_@dots{}
7624@item PUT_SDB_@dots{}
7625Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
7626SDB assembler directives.  See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
7627macros and their arguments.  If the standard syntax is used, you need
7628not define them yourself.
7629
7630@findex SDB_DELIM
7631@item SDB_DELIM
7632Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
7633SDB assembler directives.  In that case, define this macro to be the
7634delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}).  It is not necessary to define
7635a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
7636required.
7637
7638@findex SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
7639@item SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
7640Define this macro to override the usual method of constructing a dummy
7641name for anonymous structure and union types.  See @file{sdbout.c} for
7642more information.
7643
7644@findex SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
7645@item SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
7646Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
7647union, or enumeration tags to be emitted.  Standard COFF does not
7648allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
7649it.
7650
7651@findex SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
7652@item SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
7653Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
7654enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled.  Some
7655assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
7656@end table
7657
7658@need 2000
7659@node VMS Debug
7660@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
7661
7662@c prevent bad page break with this line
7663Here are macros for VMS debug format.
7664
7665@table @code
7666@findex VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
7667@item VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
7668Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
7669in response to the @option{-g} option.  The default behavior for VMS
7670is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
7671@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}.  This
7672behavior is controlled by @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} and
7673@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.
7674@end table
7675
7676@node Cross-compilation
7677@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
7678@cindex cross compilation and floating point
7679@cindex floating point and cross compilation
7680
7681While all modern machines use 2's complement representation for integers,
7682there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers.  This
7683means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
7684in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
7685doing the compilation.
7686
7687@findex atof
7688Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
7689range and precision, the cross compiler cannot safely use the host
7690machine's floating point arithmetic.  Therefore, floating point constants
7691must be represented in the target machine's format.  This means that the
7692cross compiler cannot use @code{atof} to parse a floating point constant;
7693it must have its own special routine to use instead.  Also, constant
7694folding must emulate the target machine's arithmetic (or must not be done
7695at all).
7696
7697The macros in the following table should be defined only if you are cross
7698compiling between different floating point formats.
7699
7700Otherwise, don't define them.  Then default definitions will be set up which
7701use @code{double} as the data type, @code{==} to test for equality, etc.
7702
7703You don't need to worry about how many times you use an operand of any
7704of these macros.  The compiler never uses operands which have side effects.
7705
7706@table @code
7707@findex REAL_VALUE_TYPE
7708@item REAL_VALUE_TYPE
7709A macro for the C data type to be used to hold a floating point value
7710in the target machine's format.  Typically this would be a
7711@code{struct} containing an array of @code{int}.
7712
7713@findex REAL_VALUES_EQUAL
7714@item REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (@var{x}, @var{y})
7715A macro for a C expression which compares for equality the two values,
7716@var{x} and @var{y}, both of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7717
7718@findex REAL_VALUES_LESS
7719@item REAL_VALUES_LESS (@var{x}, @var{y})
7720A macro for a C expression which tests whether @var{x} is less than
7721@var{y}, both values being of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} and
7722interpreted as floating point numbers in the target machine's
7723representation.
7724
7725@findex REAL_VALUE_LDEXP
7726@findex ldexp
7727@item REAL_VALUE_LDEXP (@var{x}, @var{scale})
7728A macro for a C expression which performs the standard library
7729function @code{ldexp}, but using the target machine's floating point
7730representation.  Both @var{x} and the value of the expression have
7731type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.  The second argument, @var{scale}, is an
7732integer.
7733
7734@findex REAL_VALUE_FIX
7735@item REAL_VALUE_FIX (@var{x})
7736A macro whose definition is a C expression to convert the target-machine
7737floating point value @var{x} to a signed integer.  @var{x} has type
7738@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7739
7740@findex REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX
7741@item REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (@var{x})
7742A macro whose definition is a C expression to convert the target-machine
7743floating point value @var{x} to an unsigned integer.  @var{x} has type
7744@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7745
7746@findex REAL_VALUE_RNDZINT
7747@item REAL_VALUE_RNDZINT (@var{x})
7748A macro whose definition is a C expression to round the target-machine
7749floating point value @var{x} towards zero to an integer value (but still
7750as a floating point number).  @var{x} has type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE},
7751and so does the value.
7752
7753@findex REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_RNDZINT
7754@item REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_RNDZINT (@var{x})
7755A macro whose definition is a C expression to round the target-machine
7756floating point value @var{x} towards zero to an unsigned integer value
7757(but still represented as a floating point number).  @var{x} has type
7758@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, and so does the value.
7759
7760@findex REAL_VALUE_ATOF
7761@item REAL_VALUE_ATOF (@var{string}, @var{mode})
7762A macro for a C expression which converts @var{string}, an expression of
7763type @code{char *}, into a floating point number in the target machine's
7764representation for mode @var{mode}.  The value has type
7765@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7766
7767@findex REAL_INFINITY
7768@item REAL_INFINITY
7769Define this macro if infinity is a possible floating point value, and
7770therefore division by 0 is legitimate.
7771
7772@findex REAL_VALUE_ISINF
7773@findex isinf
7774@item REAL_VALUE_ISINF (@var{x})
7775A macro for a C expression which determines whether @var{x}, a floating
7776point value, is infinity.  The value has type @code{int}.
7777By default, this is defined to call @code{isinf}.
7778
7779@findex REAL_VALUE_ISNAN
7780@findex isnan
7781@item REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (@var{x})
7782A macro for a C expression which determines whether @var{x}, a floating
7783point value, is a ``nan'' (not-a-number).  The value has type
7784@code{int}.  By default, this is defined to call @code{isnan}.
7785@end table
7786
7787@cindex constant folding and floating point
7788Define the following additional macros if you want to make floating
7789point constant folding work while cross compiling.  If you don't
7790define them, cross compilation is still possible, but constant folding
7791will not happen for floating point values.
7792
7793@table @code
7794@findex REAL_ARITHMETIC
7795@item REAL_ARITHMETIC (@var{output}, @var{code}, @var{x}, @var{y})
7796A macro for a C statement which calculates an arithmetic operation of
7797the two floating point values @var{x} and @var{y}, both of type
7798@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} in the target machine's representation, to
7799produce a result of the same type and representation which is stored
7800in @var{output} (which will be a variable).
7801
7802The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}, a tree code
7803which will always be one of the following: @code{PLUS_EXPR},
7804@code{MINUS_EXPR}, @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR},
7805@code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
7806
7807@cindex overflow while constant folding
7808The expansion of this macro is responsible for checking for overflow.
7809If overflow happens, the macro expansion should execute the statement
7810@code{return 0;}, which indicates the inability to perform the
7811arithmetic operation requested.
7812
7813@findex REAL_VALUE_NEGATE
7814@item REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (@var{x})
7815A macro for a C expression which returns the negative of the floating
7816point value @var{x}.  Both @var{x} and the value of the expression
7817have type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} and are in the target machine's
7818floating point representation.
7819
7820There is no way for this macro to report overflow, since overflow
7821can't happen in the negation operation.
7822
7823@findex REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE
7824@item REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (@var{mode}, @var{x})
7825A macro for a C expression which converts the floating point value
7826@var{x} to mode @var{mode}.
7827
7828Both @var{x} and the value of the expression are in the target machine's
7829floating point representation and have type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7830However, the value should have an appropriate bit pattern to be output
7831properly as a floating constant whose precision accords with mode
7832@var{mode}.
7833
7834There is no way for this macro to report overflow.
7835
7836@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_INT
7837@item REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (@var{low}, @var{high}, @var{x})
7838A macro for a C expression which converts a floating point value
7839@var{x} into a double-precision integer which is then stored into
7840@var{low} and @var{high}, two variables of type @var{int}.
7841
7842@item REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (@var{x}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{mode})
7843@findex REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT
7844A macro for a C expression which converts a double-precision integer
7845found in @var{low} and @var{high}, two variables of type @var{int},
7846into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}.
7847The value is in the target machine's representation for mode @var{mode}
7848and has the type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7849@end table
7850
7851@node Mode Switching
7852@section Mode Switching Instructions
7853@cindex mode switching
7854The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
7855
7856@table @code
7857@findex OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING
7858@item OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
7859Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
7860switching in an optimizing compilation.
7861
7862For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
7863floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
7864the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
7865operation, this bit has to be set.  Changing the PR bit requires a general
7866purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
7867be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
7868or @code{MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
7869
7870You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
7871which entities actually need it.  @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
7872return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
7873If you define this macro, you also have to define
7874@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
7875@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
7876@code{NORMAL_MODE} is optional.
7877
7878@findex NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
7879@item NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
7880If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
7881initializer for an array of integers.  Each initializer element
7882N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
7883of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
7884The position of the initializer in the initializer - starting counting at
7885zero - determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
7886entity in question.
7887In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
7888represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1.  N is used to specify that no mode
7889switch is needed / supplied.
7890
7891@findex MODE_NEEDED
7892@item MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
7893@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity.  If
7894@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
7895return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
7896@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
7897be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
7898
7899@findex NORMAL_MODE
7900@item NORMAL_MODE (@var{entity})
7901If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
7902mode switching.  It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
7903@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry and exit.
7904
7905@findex MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE
7906@item MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
7907This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
79080 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
7909lowest.  The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
7910for @var{entity}.  For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
7911(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
7912@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
7913
7914@findex EMIT_MODE_SET
7915@item EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
7916Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
7917@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
7918the insn(s) are to be inserted.
7919@end table
7920
7921@node Target Attributes
7922@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
7923@cindex target attributes
7924@cindex machine attributes
7925@cindex attributes, target-specific
7926
7927Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
7928These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
7929be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
7930
7931@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
7932If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
7933attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
7934specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
7935entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
7936take.
7937@end deftypevr
7938
7939@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
7940If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
7941@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
7942and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
7943generated).  If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
7944supposed always to be compatible.
7945@end deftypefn
7946
7947@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
7948If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
7949newly defined @var{type}.
7950@end deftypefn
7951
7952@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
7953Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
7954handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
7955@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}.  It is assumed
7956that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1.  This
7957function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
7958merging.
7959@end deftypefn
7960
7961@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
7962Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
7963handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
7964@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
7965@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}.  Examples of
7966when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
7967attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition.  This function may
7968call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
7969
7970@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
7971If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport} for
7972Windows targets, you should define the macro
7973@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  This links in a function
7974called @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined
7975as the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  This is done
7976in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
7977@end deftypefn
7978
7979@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
7980Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
7981when it is being created.  This is normally useful for back ends which
7982wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
7983the pragma's effect.  The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
7984created.  The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
7985for this decl.  The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
7986shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
7987the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
7988attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
7989needed.
7990@end deftypefn
7991
7992@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (tree @var{fndecl})
7993@cindex inlining
7994This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
7995into the current function, despite its having target-specific
7996attributes, @code{false} otherwise.  By default, if a function has a
7997target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
7998@end deftypefn
7999
8000@node Misc
8001@section Miscellaneous Parameters
8002@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
8003
8004@c prevent bad page break with this line
8005Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
8006
8007@table @code
8008@item PREDICATE_CODES
8009@findex PREDICATE_CODES
8010Define this if you have defined special-purpose predicates in the file
8011@file{@var{machine}.c}.  This macro is called within an initializer of an
8012array of structures.  The first field in the structure is the name of a
8013predicate and the second field is an array of rtl codes.  For each
8014predicate, list all rtl codes that can be in expressions matched by the
8015predicate.  The list should have a trailing comma.  Here is an example
8016of two entries in the list for a typical RISC machine:
8017
8018@smallexample
8019#define PREDICATE_CODES \
8020  @{"gen_reg_rtx_operand", @{SUBREG, REG@}@},  \
8021  @{"reg_or_short_cint_operand", @{SUBREG, REG, CONST_INT@}@},
8022@end smallexample
8023
8024Defining this macro does not affect the generated code (however,
8025incorrect definitions that omit an rtl code that may be matched by the
8026predicate can cause the compiler to malfunction).  Instead, it allows
8027the table built by @file{genrecog} to be more compact and efficient,
8028thus speeding up the compiler.  The most important predicates to include
8029in the list specified by this macro are those used in the most insn
8030patterns.
8031
8032For each predicate function named in @code{PREDICATE_CODES}, a
8033declaration will be generated in @file{insn-codes.h}.
8034
8035@item SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
8036@findex SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
8037Define this if you have special predicates that know special things
8038about modes.  Genrecog will warn about certain forms of
8039@code{match_operand} without a mode; if the operand predicate is
8040listed in @code{SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES}, the warning will be
8041suppressed.
8042
8043Here is an example from the IA-32 port (@code{ext_register_operand}
8044specially checks for @code{HImode} or @code{SImode} in preparation
8045for a byte extraction from @code{%ah} etc.).
8046
8047@smallexample
8048#define SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES \
8049  "ext_register_operand",
8050@end smallexample
8051
8052@findex CASE_VECTOR_MODE
8053@item CASE_VECTOR_MODE
8054An alias for a machine mode name.  This is the machine mode that
8055elements of a jump-table should have.
8056
8057@findex CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE
8058@item CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
8059Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
8060when the minimum and maximum offset are known.  If you define this,
8061it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
8062To make this work, you also have to define INSN_ALIGN and
8063make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
8064The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
8065flags can be updated.
8066
8067@findex CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
8068@item CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
8069Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
8070should contain relative addresses.  If jump-tables never contain
8071relative addresses, then you need not define this macro.
8072
8073@findex CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
8074@item CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
8075Define this if control falls through a @code{case} insn when the index
8076value is out of range.  This means the specified default-label is
8077actually ignored by the @code{case} insn proper.
8078
8079@findex CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8080@item CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8081Define this to be the smallest number of different values for which it
8082is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
8083The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
8084five otherwise.  This is best for most machines.
8085
8086@findex WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
8087@item WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
8088Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
8089smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
8090Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
8091
8092@findex LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8093@item LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mode})
8094Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
8095memory in @var{mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
8096bits outside of @var{mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
8097zero-extension of the data read.  Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
8098of @var{mode} for which the
8099insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
8100@code{NIL} for other modes.
8101
8102This macro is not called with @var{mode} non-integral or with a width
8103greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
8104value in this case.  Do not define this macro if it would always return
8105@code{NIL}.  On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
8106define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
8107
8108@findex SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8109@item SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8110Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
8111extends.
8112
8113@findex FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8114@item FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8115Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
8116point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
8117unsigned one.
8118
8119@findex MOVE_MAX
8120@item MOVE_MAX
8121The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8122between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
8123
8124@findex MAX_MOVE_MAX
8125@item MAX_MOVE_MAX
8126The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8127between memory and registers or between two memory locations.  If this
8128is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}.  Otherwise, it is the
8129constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
8130at run-time.
8131
8132@findex SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8133@item SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8134A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
8135actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
8136of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted.  When
8137this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
8138a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
8139truncates the count of a shift operation.  On machines that have
8140instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
8141include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
8142also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
8143arguments to bit-field instructions.
8144
8145If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
8146position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
8147instructions exist, you should define this macro.
8148
8149However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
8150only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
8151bit-field operations.  Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
8152such machines.  Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
8153the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
8154
8155You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
8156
8157@findex TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION
8158@item TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
8159A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
8160``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
8161bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
8162operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
8163
8164On many machines, this expression can be 1.
8165
8166@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that".  this was
8167@c to fix an overfull hbox.  --mew 10feb93
8168When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
8169modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
8170If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
8171such cases may improve things.
8172
8173@findex STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8174@item STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8175A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
8176with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
8177(@samp{s@var{cond}}) when the condition is true.  This description must
8178apply to @emph{all} the @samp{s@var{cond}} patterns and all the
8179comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
8180
8181A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
8182comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
8183and 0 when the comparison is false.  Otherwise, the value indicates
8184which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
8185true.  This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
8186operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
8187@samp{s@var{cond}} pattern.  Either the low bit or the sign bit of
8188@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on.  Presently, only those bits are used by
8189the compiler.
8190
8191If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
8192generate code that depends only on the specified bits.  It can also
8193replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
8194the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
8195For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
8196@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
8197@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
8198expression
8199
8200@smallexample
8201(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
8202@end smallexample
8203
8204@noindent
8205can be converted to
8206
8207@smallexample
8208(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
8209@end smallexample
8210
8211@noindent
8212where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
8213tested into the sign bit.
8214
8215There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
8216for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
8217but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction.  If you
8218are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
8219perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
8220comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
8221
8222Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
8223from a comparison (or the condition codes).  Here are rules to guide the
8224choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
8225to be used:
8226
8227@itemize @bullet
8228@item
8229Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
8230@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}.  It is more efficient for the compiler to
8231``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
8232comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
8233combine the normalization with other operations.
8234
8235@item
8236For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
8237slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
8238other machines.
8239
8240@item
8241As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
8242exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
8243others.
8244
8245@item
8246Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
8247@end itemize
8248
8249Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
8250@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
8251instructions.  On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
8252those cases, e.g., one matching
8253
8254@smallexample
8255(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
8256@end smallexample
8257
8258Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
8259condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
8260@samp{s@var{cond}} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}.  On those
8261machines, define the appropriate patterns.  Use the names @code{incscc}
8262and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
8263@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values.  See
8264@file{rs6000.md} for some examples.  The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
8265find such instruction sequences on other machines.
8266
8267You need not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
8268instructions.
8269
8270@findex FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8271@item FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
8272A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
8273returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
8274Define this macro on machine that have comparison operations that return
8275floating-point values.  If there are no such operations, do not define
8276this macro.
8277
8278@findex Pmode
8279@item Pmode
8280An alias for the machine mode for pointers.  On most machines, define
8281this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
8282pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
8283On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
8284modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
8285
8286The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
8287@code{POINTER_SIZE}.  If it is not equal, you must define the macro
8288@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
8289to @code{Pmode}.
8290
8291@findex FUNCTION_MODE
8292@item FUNCTION_MODE
8293An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
8294being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions.  On most machines this
8295should be @code{QImode}.
8296
8297@findex INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD
8298@item INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD (@var{decl})
8299A C expression for the maximum number of instructions above which the
8300function @var{decl} should not be inlined.  @var{decl} is a
8301@code{FUNCTION_DECL} node.
8302
8303The default definition of this macro is 64 plus 8 times the number of
8304arguments that the function accepts.  Some people think a larger
8305threshold should be used on RISC machines.
8306
8307@findex STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8308@item STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8309In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
8310constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@.  On some
8311hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
8312where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
8313strict conformance to the C Standard.
8314
8315Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
8316convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
8317files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
8318
8319@findex SCCS_DIRECTIVE
8320@item SCCS_DIRECTIVE
8321Define this if the preprocessor should ignore @code{#sccs} directives
8322and print no error message.
8323
8324@findex NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8325@item NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8326Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
8327This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
8328C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
8329@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
8330
8331@findex HANDLE_PRAGMA
8332@item HANDLE_PRAGMA (@var{getc}, @var{ungetc}, @var{name})
8333This macro is no longer supported.  You must use
8334@code{REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS} instead.
8335
8336@findex REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS
8337@findex #pragma
8338@findex pragma
8339@item REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS (@var{pfile})
8340Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
8341If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
8342@code{cpp_register_pragma} for each pragma, with @var{pfile} passed as
8343the first argument to to these functions.  The macro may also do any
8344setup required for the pragmas.
8345
8346The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
8347other compilers for the same target.  In general, we discourage
8348definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
8349
8350If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
8351defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
8352
8353Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded.  All
8354@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
8355silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
8356
8357@deftypefun void cpp_register_pragma (cpp_reader *@var{pfile}, const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (cpp_reader *))
8358
8359Each call to @code{cpp_register_pragma} establishes one pragma.  The
8360@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
8361pragma of the form
8362
8363@smallexample
8364#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
8365@end smallexample
8366
8367@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
8368@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace.  The callback
8369routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
8370on to cpplib's functions if necessary.  You can lex tokens after the
8371@var{name} by calling @code{c_lex}.  Tokens that are not read by the
8372callback will be silently ignored.  The end of the line is indicated by
8373a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}.
8374
8375For an example use of this routine, see @file{c4x.h} and the callback
8376routines defined in @file{c4x-c.c}.
8377
8378Note that the use of @code{c_lex} is specific to the C and C++
8379compilers.  It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
8380other language compilers for that matter.  Thus if @code{c_lex} is going
8381to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
8382building the C and C++ compilers.  This can be done by defining the
8383variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
8384target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file.  These variables should name
8385the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
8386code that uses @code{c_lex}.  Note it will also be necessary to add a
8387rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
8388how to build this object file.
8389@end deftypefun
8390
8391@findex HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8392@findex #pragma
8393@findex pragma
8394@item HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8395Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
8396pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
8397[=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
8398
8399The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
8400within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
8401@samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do.  A pack value of zero resets
8402the behavior to the default.
8403
8404The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
8405@code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined.  If enabled it allows the creation
8406of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
8407
8408@findex HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8409@findex #pragma
8410@findex pragma
8411@item HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8412Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
8413style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push,@var{n})} and @samp{#pragma
8414pack(pop)}.  The @samp{pack(push,@var{n})} pragma specifies the maximum alignment
8415(in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as the
8416@samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do.  A
8417pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default.  Successive
8418invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
8419that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
8420value.
8421
8422@findex DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
8423@item DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
8424Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in identifier
8425names.  0 means @samp{$} is not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed.
84261 is the default; there is no need to define this macro in that case.
8427This macro controls the compiler proper; it does not affect the preprocessor.
8428
8429@findex NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8430@item NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8431Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8432@samp{$} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in
8433G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers.  If this macro is defined,
8434@samp{.} is used instead.
8435
8436@findex NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8437@item NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8438Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8439@samp{.} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in G++
8440have names that use @samp{.}.  If this macro is defined, these names
8441are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
8442
8443@findex DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
8444@item DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
8445Define this macro if the target system expects every program's @code{main}
8446function to return a standard ``success'' value by default (if no other
8447value is explicitly returned).
8448
8449The definition should be a C statement (sans semicolon) to generate the
8450appropriate rtl instructions.  It is used only when compiling the end of
8451@code{main}.
8452
8453@item NEED_ATEXIT
8454@findex NEED_ATEXIT
8455Define this if the target system lacks the function @code{atexit}
8456from the ISO C standard.  If this macro is defined, a default definition
8457will be provided to support C++.  If @code{ON_EXIT} is not defined,
8458a default @code{exit} function will also be provided.
8459
8460@item ON_EXIT
8461@findex ON_EXIT
8462Define this macro if the target has another way to implement atexit
8463functionality without replacing @code{exit}.  For instance, SunOS 4 has
8464a similar @code{on_exit} library function.
8465
8466The definition should be a functional macro which can be used just like
8467the @code{atexit} function.
8468
8469@item EXIT_BODY
8470@findex EXIT_BODY
8471Define this if your @code{exit} function needs to do something
8472besides calling an external function @code{_cleanup} before
8473terminating with @code{_exit}.  The @code{EXIT_BODY} macro is
8474only needed if @code{NEED_ATEXIT} is defined and @code{ON_EXIT} is not
8475defined.
8476
8477@findex INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED
8478@item INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
8479Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
8480delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
8481even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
8482@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
8483every @code{call_insn} has this behavior.  On machines where some @code{insn}
8484or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
8485you should define this macro.
8486
8487You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
8488
8489@findex INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED
8490@item INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
8491Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
8492delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
8493even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
8494@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}.  On machines where
8495some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
8496are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
8497define this macro.  Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
8498instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
8499slot of @var{insn}.
8500
8501You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
8502
8503@findex MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
8504@item MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (@var{insn})
8505In rare cases, correct code generation requires extra machine
8506dependent processing between the second jump optimization pass and
8507delayed branch scheduling.  On those machines, define this macro as a C
8508statement to act on the code starting at @var{insn}.
8509
8510@findex MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
8511@item MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
8512Define this macro if in some cases global symbols from one translation
8513unit may not be bound to undefined symbols in another translation unit
8514without user intervention.  For instance, under Microsoft Windows
8515symbols must be explicitly imported from shared libraries (DLLs).
8516
8517@findex MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
8518@item MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (@var{clobbers})
8519A C statement that adds to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
8520any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for all asms.
8521
8522@findex MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
8523@item MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
8524Define this to the largest integer machine mode which can be used for
8525operations other than load, store and copy operations.
8526
8527You need only define this macro if the target holds values larger than
8528@code{word_mode} in general purpose registers.  Most targets should not define
8529this macro.
8530
8531@findex MATH_LIBRARY
8532@item MATH_LIBRARY
8533Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
8534in the system math library, or @samp{""} if the target does not have a
8535separate math library.
8536
8537You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"-lm"} is wrong.
8538
8539@findex LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
8540@item LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
8541Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
8542specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
8543
8544You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
8545is wrong.
8546
8547@findex TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
8548@item TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
8549Define this macro if the target supports file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
8550Note that this functionality is part of POSIX@.
8551Defining @code{TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW} will enable the test coverage code
8552to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
8553if the program has forked.
8554
8555@findex MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
8556@item MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
8557
8558A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
8559conditional execution instructions instead of a branch.  A value of
8560@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
85611 if it does use cc0.
8562
8563@findex IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS
8564@item IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS
8565A C expression to modify the tests in @code{TRUE_EXPR}, and
8566@code{FALSE_EXPR} for use in converting insns in @code{TEST_BB},
8567@code{THEN_BB}, @code{ELSE_BB}, and @code{JOIN_BB} basic blocks to
8568conditional execution.  Set either @code{TRUE_EXPR} or @code{FALSE_EXPR}
8569to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
8570
8571@findex IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN
8572@item IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN
8573A C expression to modify the @code{PATTERN} of an @code{INSN} that is to
8574be converted to conditional execution format.
8575
8576@findex IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL
8577@item IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL
8578A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
8579converting code to conditional execution in the basic blocks
8580@code{TEST_BB}, @code{THEN_BB}, @code{ELSE_BB}, and @code{JOIN_BB}.
8581
8582@findex IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL
8583@item IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL
8584A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
8585converting code to conditional execution in the basic blocks
8586@code{TEST_BB}, @code{THEN_BB}, @code{ELSE_BB}, and @code{JOIN_BB}.
8587@end table
8588
8589@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS ()
8590Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
8591that need to be defined.  It should be a function that performs the
8592necessary setup.
8593
8594Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
8595instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
8596they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
8597instructions or prefetch instructions).
8598
8599To create a built-in function, call the function @code{builtin_function}
8600which is defined by the language front end.  You can use any type nodes set
8601up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
8602only language front ends that use those two functions will call
8603@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
8604@end deftypefn
8605
8606@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
8607
8608Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
8609@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  @var{exp} is the expression for the
8610function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
8611convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
8612@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
8613@var{exp}'s operands.  @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
8614ignored.  This function should return the result of the call to the
8615built-in function.
8616@end deftypefn
8617
8618@table @code
8619@findex MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH
8620@item MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH(@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
8621
8622Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
8623Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
8624@var{branch2} is possible.
8625
8626On some targets, branches may have a limited range.  Optimizing the
8627filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
8628may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
8629
8630@findex ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
8631@item ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE(@var{hard_reg})
8632
8633When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
8634register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
8635to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
8636it has been saved into can be used.  @code{ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}, if
8637defined, is called at the start of register allocation once for each
8638hard register that had its initial value copied by using
8639@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
8640Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
8641to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
8642the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
8643@code{MEM}.
8644If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
8645it might decide to use another register anyways.
8646You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the definition of the
8647macro, functions that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
8648register in question will not be clobbered.
8649
8650@findex TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
8651@item TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
8652Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
8653files on your target machine.  If you do not define this macro, GCC will
8654use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
8655
8656@findex TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
8657@item TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
8658Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
8659automatically added to executable files on your target machine.  If you
8660do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
8661executable files.
8662
8663@findex COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
8664@item COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
8665If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
8666specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
8667Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
8668object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
8669lists.
8670
8671@end table
8672
8673@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
8674This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
8675instructions could be created.  On machines that require a register for
8676every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
8677reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
8678
8679@smallexample
8680static bool
8681cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
8682@{
8683  return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
8684@}
8685@end smallexample
8686@end deftypefn
8687